The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol within an equilateral triangle is
intended to alert the user to the presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage”
within the product’s enclosure that may be of suffi cient magnitude to constitute
a risk of electric shock to persons.
The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert the
user to the presence of important operating and maintenance (servicing)
instructions in the literature accompanying the product.
WARNING
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK,
DO NOT EXPOSE THIS APPLIANCE TO RAIN OR MOISTURE.
CAUTION: TO PREVENT ELECTRIC SHOCK, MATCH WIDE BLADE OF PLUG
TO WIDE SLOT, FULLY INSERT.
ATTENTION: POUR ÉVITER LES CHOCS ÉLECTRIQUES, INTRODUIRE LA
LAME LA PLUS LARGE DE LA FICHE DANS LA BORNE CORRESPONDANTE
DE LA PRISE ET POUSSER JUSQU’AU FOND.
NOTE TO CATV SYSTEM INSTALLER:
This reminder is provided to call the CATV (Cable-TV) system installer’s attention to Section 820-40 of the
NEC which provides guidelines for proper grounding and, in particular, specifi es that the cable ground shall
be connected to the grounding system of the building, as close to the point of cable entry as practical.
NOTE:
This equipment has been tested and found to comply
with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant
to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are
designed to provide reasonable protection against
harmful interference in a residential installation. This
equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio
frequency energy and, if not installed and used in
accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful
interference to radio communications. However,
there is no guarantee that interference will not occur
in a particular installation. If this equipment does
cause harmful interference to radio or television
reception, which can be determined by tuning the
equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to
try to correct the interference by one or more of the
following measures:
- Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
- Increase the separation between the equipment
and receiver.
- Connect the equipment into an outlet on a
circuit different from that to which the receiver is
connected.
- Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV
technician for help.
NOTE:
Changes or modifi cations not expressly approved by
the party responsible for compliance could void the
user’s authority to operate the equipment.
IMPORTANT SAFETY
INSTRUCTIONS
READ BEFORE OPERATING EQUIPMENT
This product was designed and manufactured to
meet strict quality and safety standards. There are,
however, some installation and operation precautions
which you should be particularly aware of.
1. Read Instructions – All the safety and
operating instructions should be read before
the product is operated.
2. Retain Instructions – The safety and
operating instructions should be retained for
future reference.
3. Heed Warnings – All warnings on the product
and in the operating instructions should be
adhered to.
4. Follow Instructions – All operating and use
instructions should be followed.
5. Cleaning – Unplug this product from the
wall outlet before cleaning. Do not use liquid
cleaners or aerosol cleaners. Use a damp
cloth for cleaning.
6. Attachments – Do not use attachments not
recommended by the product manufacturer
as they may cause hazards.
7. Water and Moisture – Do not use this product
near water-for example, near a bath tub,
wash bowl, kitchen sink, or laundry tub, in a
wet basement, or near a swimming pool, and
the like.
8. Accessories – Do not place this product on
an unstable cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or
table. The product may fall, causing serious
injury to a child or adult, and serious damage
to the product. Use only with a cart, stand,
tripod, bracket, or table recommended by the
manufacturer, or sold with the product. Any
mounting of the product should follow the
manufacturer’s instructions, and should use
a mounting accessory recommended by the
manufacturer.
9. A product and cart combination should be
moved with care. Quick stops, excessive
force, and uneven surfaces may cause the
product and cart combination to overturn.
10. Ventilation – Slots and openings in the
cabinet are provided for ventilation and to
ensure reliable operation of the product and
to protect it from overheating, and these
openings must not be blocked or covered.
The openings should never be blocked by
placing the product on a bed, sofa, rug, or
other similar surface. This product should not
be placed in a built-in installation such as a
bookcase or rack unless proper ventilation is
provided or the manufacturer’s instructions
have been adhered to.
11. Power Sources – This product should be
operated only from the type of power source
indicated on the marking label. If you are
not sure of the type of power supply to your
home, consult your product dealer or local
power company. For products intended to
operate from battery power, or other sources,
refer to the operating instructions.
12.
Grounding or Polarization – This product may
be equipped with a polarized alternatingcurrent
line plug (a plug having one blade wider than
the other). This plug will fit into the power
outlet only one way. This is a safety feature. If
you are unable to insert the plug fully into the
outlet, try reversing the plug. If the plug should
still fail to fi t, contact your electrician to replace
your obsolete outlet. Do not defeat the safety
purpose of the polarized plug.
AC POLARIZED PLUG
13. Power-Cord Protection – Power-supply cords
should be routed so that they are not likely
to be walked on or pinched by items placed
upon or against them, paying particular
attention to cords at plugs, convenience
receptacles, and the point where they exit
from the product.
14. Protective Attachment Plug – The product
is equipped with an attachment plug having
overload protection. This is a safety feature.
See Instruction Manual for replacement or
resetting of protective device. If replacement
of the plug is required, be sure the service
technician has used a replacement plug
specified by the manufacturer that has the
same overload protection as the original plug.
15. Outdoor Antenna Grounding – If an outside
antenna or cable system is connected to the
product, be sure the antenna or cable system
is grounded so as to provide some protection
against voltage surges and built-up static
charges. Article 810 of the National Electrical
Code, ANSI/NFPA 70, provides information
with regard to proper grounding of the mast
and supporting structure, grounding of
the lead-in wire to an antenna-discharge
unit, size of grounding conductors, location
of antennadischarge unit, connection to
grounding electrodes, and requirements for
the grounding electrode. See Figure 1.
16. Lightning – For added protection for this
product during a lightning storm, or when it is
left unattended and unused for long periods
of time, unplug it from the wall outlet and
disconnect the antenna or cable system. This
will prevent damage to the product due to
lightning and power-line surges.
17.
Power Lines – An outside antenna system
should not be located in the vicinity of overhead
power lines or other electric light or power
circuits, or where it can fall into such power
lines or circuits. When installing an outside
antenna system, extreme care should be taken
to keep from touching such power lines or
circuits as contact with them might be fatal.
18. Overloading – Do not overload wall outlets,
extension cords, or integral convenience
receptacles as this can result in a risk of fi re
or electric shock.
19. Object and Liquid Entry – Never push objects
of any kind into this product through openings
as they may touch dangerous voltage points
or short-out parts that could result in a fi re or
electric shock. Never spill liquid of any kind
on the product.
20. Servicing – Do not attempt to service this
product yourself as opening or removing
covers may expose you to dangerous voltage
or other hazards. Refer all servicing to
qualifi ed service personnel.
21. Damage Requiring Service – Unplug
this product from the wall outlet and refer
servicing to qualifi ed service personnel under
the following conditions:
a. When the power-supply cord or plug is
damaged.
b. If liquid has been spilled, or objects have
fallen into the product.
c. If the product has been exposed to rain or
water.
d. If the product does not operate normally by
following the operating instructions. Adjust
only those controls that are covered by
the operating instructions as an improper
adjustment of other controls may result in
damage and will often require extensive
work by a qualifi ed technician to restore the
product to its normal operation.
e. If the product has been dropped or damaged
in any way, and
f. When the product exhibits a distinct change
in performance this indicates a need for
service.
22. Replacement Parts – When replacement
parts are required, be sure the service
technician has used replacement parts
specified by the manufacturer or have the
same characteristics as the original part.
Unauthorized substitutions may result in fi re,
electric shock, or other hazards.
23. Safety Check – Upon completion of any
service or repairs to this product, ask the
service technician to perform safety checks
to determine that the product is in proper
operating condition.
24. Wall or Ceiling Mounting – The product
should be mounted to a wall or ceiling only as
recommended by the manufacturer.
EXAMPLE OF ANTENNA GROUNDING AS PER
NATIONAL ELECTRICAL CODE, ANSI/NFPA 70
GROUND
CLAMP
ELECTRIC
SERVICE
EQUIPMENT
GROUND CLAMPS
NEC - NATIONAL ELECTRICAL CODE
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian
ICES-003.
25. Heat – The product should be situated away
from heat sources such as radiators, heat
registers, stoves, or other products (including
amplifi ers) that produce heat.
FIGURE 1
ANTENNA
LEAD IN WIRE
ANTENNA
DISCHARGE UNIT
(NEC SECTION 810-20)
GROUNDING CONDUCTORS
(NEC SECTION 810-21)
POWER SERVICE GROUNDING
ELECTRODE SYSTEM
(NEC ART 250, PART H)
Cet appareil numérique de la Classe B est conforme
à la norme NMB-003 du Canada.
DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the
following conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this
device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause
undesired operation.
Thank you for purchasing the Marantz SR7002/SR8002 Surround receiver.
This remarkable component has been engineered to provide you with many years of home theater enjoyment.
Please take a few minutes to read this manual thoroughly before you connect and operate the SR7002/
SR8002.
As there are a number of connection and confi guration options, you are encouraged to discuss your own
particular home theater setup with your Marantz A/V specialist dealer.
ACCESSORIES CHECK
Before use, check the below accessories were
included in the package.
XM SATELLITE RADIO ....................................................81
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS ..........82
FEATURES
This unit incorporates the latest generation of digital
surround sound decoding technology such as Dolby
Digital EX, Dolby Digital, DTS ES (Discrete 6.1 and
Matrix 6.1), DTS Neo:6 (Cinema, Music), Dolby ProLogic II (Movie, Music and Game), Dolby Pro-Logic
II x (Movie, Music and Game), Circle Surround II
(Cinema, Music and Mono).
Additionally, the unit is compatible with Dolby TrueHD
and DTS-HD (as used for Blu-ray and HD DVD discs)
as well as Dolby Digital Plus, an expanded and
improved version of Dolby Digital positioned as the
next-generation delivery format. These audio formats
can be sent with video signals via an HDMI cable to
HDMI 1.3a-compatible equipment.
In addition, Marantz has focused on the future. By
utilizing pre-out jacks, 7.1 direct inputs and a RS-232C
communication port, the unit is tomorrow’s technology,
today!
• THX Select 2 certifi ed
7ch amplifi ers have enough power for even the most
diffi cult conditions found in large rooms.
Enormous power reserves endow the system with
substantial dynamic ability at high sound levels.
110 watts (SR7002) / 125 watts (SR8002) to each of
the 7 main channels the power amp section features
an advanced, premium high-storage power supply
capacitors, and fully discrete output stages housed
in cast aluminum heat sinks .
This unit incorporates the most advanced Digital
Signal Processing circuitry, along with a 192 kHz/24 bit
D/A converter in each of the 7 channels. Independent
power supply circuits are incorporated for the FL
display, audio and video sections for maximum
separation, clarity and dynamic range. Together with
hand-selected customized components, all elements
work in harmony to recreate the emotion, exactly as
the artist had intended.
This unit is designed and engineered with extensive
feedback from custom installation experts, dealers
and consumers. It features multi-room/multisource,
assignable DC trigger, a RS-232C communication
port, Flasher input, heavy duty speaker binding posts
and an extensive array of both analog and digital
inputs / outputs. With 6 assignable digital inputs (7
total), 4 component inputs, Super Audio CD Multi
Channel (7.1 channel) direct inputs, video convert
system and a speaker-B and OSD output versatility
is taken to a stunning new level. Furthermore, the
unit can output the OSD information through the Y/C
(S-video) and composite video outputs.
2
An easy-to-use programmable, learning remote
controller allows full access to all of the operating
functions and can be used for system operation as
well.
The new generation of Marantz Receivers is stylish and
completely symmetrical. On the front panel of the unit,
buttons are kept to a minimum. Source selectors and
volume controls are intuitively placed.
This unit is here to perform in your unrivaled home
entertainment setup.
• HDMI
HDMI (High-Defi nition Multimedia Interface) is an
enhancement to the DVI (Digital Visual Interface)
standard. It adds capabilities for digitally transmitting
audio signals in addition to video signals. Where
multiple cables were previously needed for audio/
video, HDMI enables audio/video connection via a
single cable.
The HDMI input jacks of this unit support HDMI Ver.
1.3a. and the HDMI output jacks of this transmitter
support HDMI Ver. 1.3a.
Copyright Protection
This unit supports HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital
Content Protection). HDCP is copyright protection
technology that consists of data encoding and other
device authentication. Its purpose is to protect digital
video content. Both this unit and the connected
component (such as a video player or monitor) must
support HDCP. Before connecting a component to
this unit, refer to its instruction manual.
• xvYCC
• Deep Color 36bit
• THX / THX Surround EX
• Dolby True HD, Dolby Digital Plus dts HD
• Dolby Digital EX, Dolby Digital, DTS ES
(Discrete 6.1, Matrix 6.1, Neo:6)
• Dolby Headphone
• Dolby Pro Logic II (Movie, Music, Game)
• Dolby Pro Logic IIx (Movie, Music, Game)
• Circle Surround II (Cinema, Music, Mono)
• HDCD
• Bi-amp drive
• Source/Pure Direct mode
• 9 bands x 7 ch GEQ
• DSD to PCM converter
• Audyssey Mult EQ
• XM Satellite Radio Ready
®
HD Surround Powered by Neural Audio
• XM
• HD Radio (SR8002 Only)
• Improved Station Name Input Method, 60 Presets
• Auto Adjust Function for Speaker Distance Settings
(Delay Time)
• Massive Energy Power Supply, Huge EI
Transformer, Large ELCO’s. (SR7002 only)
• Troidal Core Transformer (SR8002 only)
• Function Rename
• 192 kHz/24 bit DAC for all 8 Channels
• 32 bit Digital Surround Processing Chipsets
• Large Heavy Duty Speaker Terminals for all
Channels
• Auto Input Signal Detection
• Front Optical AUX Input
(Digital Camera, Portable DVD)
• Multi Room B output (SR8002 only)
• Video Off Mode
Set Up Menu via all Video Output
•
(Composite, S-Video, Component video and
HDMI)
• Video convert system
HDMI ← Component Video ↔
S-Video ↔ Composit Video
• Two component monitor outputs
• Video I/P Converter
• Selectable Multi Room Component Video output
(SR8002 only)
• RS-232C Terminal for Future Upgrade or System
Control
• Emitter Output (SR8002 only)
• Programmable, learning remote controller
• Flasher Input
• IR Recever Input (SR8002 only)
DESCRIPTION
THX® is an exclusive set of standards and technologies
established by the world-renowned fi lm production
company, Lucasfi lm Ltd. THX resulted from George
Lucas’ desire to reproduce the movie soundtrack as
faithfully as possible both in the movie theater and in
the home theater.
THX engineers developed patented technologies to
accurately translate the sound from a movie theater
environment into the home, correcting the tonal and
spatial errors that occur.
When the THX mode of the unit is on, three distinct
THX technologies are automatically added:
Re-Equalization-restores the correct tonal balance
for watching a movie in a home environment.
These sounds are otherwise mixed to be brighter
for a large movie theater. Re-EQ compensates for
this and prevents the soundtracks from being overly
bright and harsh when played in a home theater.
Timbre Matching-fi lters the information going to the
surround speakers so they more closely match the
tonal characteristics of the sound coming from the
front speakers.
This ensures seamless panning between the front
and surround speakers.
Adaptive Decorrelation-slightly changes one surround
channel’s time and phase relationship with respect to
the other surround channel.
This expands the listening position and creates with
only two surround speakers the same spacious
surround experience as in a movie theater with
multiple surround speakers.
The unit was required to pass a rigorous series
of quality and performance tests, in addition to
incorporating the technologies explained above, in
order to be THX certifi ed.
THX requirements cover ever y aspect of performance
including pre-amplifier and power amplifier
performance and operation, and hundreds of other
parameters in both the digital and analog domain.
Movies which have been encoded in Dolby Digital,
DTS, Dolby Pro Logic, stereo and Mono will all
benefi t from the THX mode when being viewed.
The THX mode should only be activated when
watching movies which were originally produced for
a movie theater environment.
THX need not be activated for music, movies
made especially for TV, or shows such as sports
programming, talk shows, etc.
This is because they were originally mixed for a small
room environment.
THX and Select 2 are trademarks of THX Ltd. THX
may be registered in some jurisdictions. Surround
EX is a trademark of Dolby Laboratories. Used with
permission.
THX Surround EX—Dolby DIgital Surround EX is a
joint development of Dolby Laboratories and THX Ltd.
In a movie theater, fi lm soundtracks that have been
encoded with Dolby Digital Surround EX technology
are able to reproduce an extra channel which has
been added during the mixing of the program. This
channel, called Surround Back, places sounds
behind the listener in addition to the currently
available front left, front center, front right, surround
right, surround left and subwoofer channels. This
additional channel provides the opportunity for more
detailed imaging behind the listener and brings more
depth, spacious ambience and sound localization
than ever before.
Movies that were created using the Dolby Digital
Surround EX technology, when released into the
home consumer market may exhibit wording to that
effect on the packaging. A list of movies created
using this technology can be found on the Dolby
web site at www.dolby.com. A list of available DVD
software titles encoded with this technology an be
found at www.thx.com.
ENGLISH
3
ENGLISH
Only receiver and controller products bearing the
THX Surround EX logo, when in the THX Surround
EX mode, faithfully reproduce this new technology
in the home. This product may also engage the
THX Surround EX mode during the playback of 5.1
channel material that is not Dolby Digital Surround
EX eocnded. In such case, the information delivered
to the Surround Back channel will be program
dependent and may or may not be very pleasing
depending on the particular soundtrack and the
tastes of the individual listener.
“SURROUND EX™” is a trademark of Dolby
Laboratories. Used under authorization.
THX Select2
Before any home theater component can be THX
Select2 certified, it must pass a rigorous series
of quality and performance tests. Only then can a
product feature the THX Select2 logo, which is your
guarantee that the Home Theater products you
purchase will give you superb performance for many
years to come. THX Select2 requirements defi ne
hundreds of parameters, including power amplifi er
performance, and pre-amplifier performance and
operation for both digital and analog domains. THX
Select2 receivers also feature proprietary THX
technologies (e.g., THX Mode) which accurately
translate movie soundtracks for home theater
playback.
Neural SurroundTM, THX® Technologies has been
chosen as the offi cial surround sound broadcast
format for XM Satellite Radio’s “XM HD Surround”
and other leading FM/HD radio stations in the USA
and worldwide. Neural Surround, THX Technologies
delivers the rich envelopment and discrete image
detail of surround sound in a format 100% compatible
with stereo.
Neural Surround, THX Technologies draws the brain’s
attention to sonic details in musical instruments,
vocals and ambience that are typically masked by
other playback systems. This allows the listener
to fully experience the richness and subtleties in
recorded performance as never before for both
surround encoded material and regular stereo
material such as CDs or digital media players. Neural
Surround, THX Technologies is enabling the second
surround sound revolution, bringing surround directly
to your ears!
4
This product is manufactured under license from
Neural Audio Corporation and THX Ltd. Marantz
hereby grants the user a non-exclusive, nontransferable, limited right of use to this product under
USA and foreign patent, patent pending and other
technology or trademarks owned by Neural Audio
Corporation and THX Ltd. “Neural Surround”, “Neural
Audio”, “Neural” and “NRL” are trademarks and
logos owned by Neural Audio Corporation, THX is a
trademark of THX Ltd., which may be registered in
some jurisdictions. All rights reserved.
DTS was introduced in 1994 to provide 5.1 channels
of discrete digital audio into home theater systems.
DTS brings you premium quality discrete multichannel
digital sound to both movies and music.
DTS is a multichannel sound system designed to
create full range digital sound reproduction.
The no compromise DTS digital process sets the
standard of quality for cinema sound by delivering
an exact copy of the studio master recordings to
neighborhood and home theaters.
Now, every moviegoer can hear the sound exactly as
the moviemaker intended.
DTS can be enjoyed in the home for either movies or
music on of DVD’s, LD’s, and CD’s.
• dts Neo:6
The advantages of discrete multichannel systems
over matrix are well known.
But even in homes equipped for discrete multichannel,
there remains a need for high-quality matrix decoding.
This is because of the large library of matrix surround
motion pictures available on disc and on VHS tape;
and analog television broadcasts.
The typical matrix decoder of today derives a center
channel and a mono surround channel from twochannel matrix stereo material. It is better than a
simple matrix in that it includes steering logic to
improve separation, but because of its mono, bandlimited surround it can be disappointing to users
accustomed to discrete multichannel.
®
Neo:6 offers several important improvements as
follow,
• Neo:6 provides up to six full-band channels of
matrix decoding from stereo matrix material. Users
with 6.1 and 5.1 systems will derive six and fi ve
separate channels, respectively, corresponding to
the standard home-theater speaker layouts.
• Neo:6 technology allows various sound elements
within a channel or channels to be steered
separately, and in a way which follows naturally
from the original presentation.
• Neo:6 offers a music mode to expand stereo
nonmatrix recordings into the fi ve- or six-channel
layout, in a way which does not diminish the subtlety
and integrity of the original stereo recording.
• dts Digital Surround ES
DTS-ES Extended Surround is a new multichannel
digital signal format developed by Digital Theater
Systems Inc. While offering high compatibility with
the conventional DTS Digital Surround format, DTSES Extended Surround greatly improves the 360degree surround impression and space expression
thanks to further expanded surround signals. This
format has been used professionally in movie
theaters since 1999.
In addition to the 5.1 surround channels (FL, FR, C,
SL, SR and LFE), DTS-ES Extended Surround also
offers the SB (Surround Back) channel for surround
playback with a total of 6.1 channels. DTS-ES
Extended Surround includes two signal formats with
different surround signal recording methods, as DTSES Discrete 6.1 and DTS-ES Matrix 6.1.
• dts Digital Surround 96/24
The stereo CD is a 16-bit medium with sampling at
44.1 kHz. Professional audio has been 20- or 24-
bit for some time, and there is increasing interest
in higher sampling rates both for recording and for
delivery into the home. Greater bit depths provide
extended dynamic range. Higher sampling rates
allow wider frequency response and the use of antialias and reconstruction fi lters with more favorable
aural characteristics.
DTS 96/24 allows for 5.1channel sound tracks to be
encoded at a rate of 96kHz/24bits on DVD-Video
titles.
When DVD-video appeared, it became possible to
deliver 24-bit, 96 kHz audio into the home, but only in
two channels, and with serious limitations on picture.
This capability has had little use.
DVD-audio allows 96/24 in six channels, but a
new player is needed, and only analog outputs are
provided, necessitating the use of the D/A converters
and analog electronics provided in the player.
®
DTS 96/24 offers the following:
1. Sound quality transparent to the original 96/24
master.
2. Full backward compatibility with all existing
decoders. (Existing decoders will output a 48 kHz
signal)
3. No new player required: DTS 96/24 can be carried
on DVD-video, or in the video zone of DVD-audio,
accessible to all DVD players.
4. 96/24 5.1-channel sound with full-quality fullmotion video, for music programs and motion
picture soundtracks on DVD-video.
DTS-HD Master Audio is capable of delivering audio
that is a bit-for-bit identical to the studio master.
DTS-HD Master Audio delivers audio at super high
variable bit rates -24.5 mega-bits per second (Mbps)
on Blu-ray discs and 18.0 Mbps on HD-DVD - that
are signifi cantly higher than standard DVDs . This bit
stream is so “fast” and the transfer rate is so “high”
that it can deliver the Holy Grail of audio: 7.1 audio
channels at 96k sampling frequency/24 bit depths
that are identical to the original. With DTS-HD Master
Audio, you will be able to experience movies and
music, exactly as the artist intended: clear, pure, and
uncompromised.
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio can deliver up to 7.1
channels of sound that is virtually indistinguishable
from the original. DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
delivers audio at high constant bit rates superior to
standard DVDs---6.0 Mbps on Blu-ray discs and 3.0
Mbps on HD-DVD to produce outstanding sound
quality. It is capable of delivering up to 7.1 channels
at 96k sampling frequency/24 bit depth resolution. It
allows content creators to deliver rich, high defi nition
audio on movies where disc space may not allow for
DTS-HD Master Audio.
Dolby Digital identifi es the use of Dolby Digital audio
coding for such consumer formats as DVD and
DTV. As with fi lm sound, Dolby Digital can provide
up to fi ve full-range channels for left, center, and
right screen channels, independent left and right
surround channels, and a sixth (“.1”) channel for lowfrequency effects.
Dolby Surround Pro Logic II is an improved matrix
decoding technology that provides better spatiality
and directionality on Dolby Surround program
material; provides a convincing three-dimensional
soundfi eld on conventional stereo music recordings;
and is ideally suited to bring the surround experience
to automotive sound. While conventional surround
programming is fully compatible with Dolby Surround
Pro Logic II decoders, soundtracks will be able to be
encoded specifi cally to take full advantage of Pro
Logic II playback, including separate left and right
surround channels. (Such material is also compatible
with conventional Pro Logic decoders.)
Dolby Digital EX creates six full-bandwidth output
channels from 5.1-channel sources. This is done
using a matrix decoder that derives three surround
channels from the two in the original recording. For
best results, Dolby Digital EX should be used with
movies soundtracks recorded with Dolby Digital
Surround EX.
About Dolby Pro Logic IIx
Dolby Pro Logic IIx technology delivers a natural
and immersing 7.1-channel listening experience
to the home theater environment. A product of
Dolby's expertise in surround sound and matrix
decoding technologies, Dolby Pro Logic IIx is a
complete surround sound solution that maximizes
the entertainment experience from stereo as well as
5.1-channel encoded sources.
Dolby Pro Logic IIx is fully compatible with Dolby
Surround Pro Logic technology and can optimally
decode the thousands of commercially available
Dolby Surround encoded video cassettes and
television programs with enhanced depth and
spatiality. It can also process any high-quality
stereo or Advanced Resolution 5.1-channel music
content into a seamless 6.1- or 7.1-channel listening
experience.
The Dolby Headphone technology provides a
surround sound listening experience over headphones.
When listening to multichannel content such as DVD
movies over headphones, the listening experience
is fundamentally different than listening to speakers.
Since the headphone speaker drivers are covering
the pinna of the ear, the listening experience differs
greatly from traditional speaker playback. Dolby
utilizes patented headphone perspective curves to
solve this problem and provides a non-fatiguing,
immersive, home theater listening experience. Dolby
Headphone also delivers exceptional 3D audio from
stereo material.
Dolby Virtual Speaker is a technologycertified
by Dolby Laboratories that creates a virtualized
surround sound experience from two speakers using
a multichannel Dolby Digital source. Additionally,
Dolby Virtual Speaker can simulate the surround
sound effect produced by Dolby Pro Logic or Dolby
Pro Logic II .
Dolby Virtual Speaker retains all the original
Multichannel audio information and provides the
listener with the sensation of being surrounded by
additional speakers.
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.
“Dolby”, “Pro Logic”, “Surround EX”, and the double-D
symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
Dolby® TrueHD is Dolby’s next-generation lossless
technology developed for high-defi nition disc-based
media. Dolby TrueHD delivers tantalizing sound
that is bit-for-bit identical to the studio master,
unlocking the true high-definition entertainment
experience on next-generation discs. When coupled
with high-defi nition video, Dolby TrueHD offers an
unprecedented home theater experience that lets
you enjoy sound as stunning as the high-defi nition
picture.
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.
“Dolby”, “Pro Logic”, “Surround EX”, and the double-D
symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
Dolby Digital Plus is a highly sophisticated and
versatile audio codec based on Dolby Digital and
designed specifically to adapt to the changing
demands of future audio, video delivery, and audio
storage systems while simultaneously retaining
backwards compatibility with the existing Dolby
Digital 5.1-channel home theater systems in use
today.
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.
“Dolby”, “Pro Logic”, “Surround EX”, and the double-D
symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
Circle Surround II (CS-II ) is a powerful and versatile
multichannel technology. CS-II is designed to enable
up to 6.1 multichannel surround sound playback
from mono, stereo, CS encoded sources and other
matrix encoded sources. In all cases the decoder
extends it into 6 channels of surround audio and a
LFE/subwoofer signal. The CS-II decoder creates a
listening environment that places the listener “inside”
music performances and dramatically improves
both hi-fi audio conventional surround-encoded
video material. CS-II provides composite stereo rear
channels to greatly improve separation and image
positioning– adding a heightened sense of realism to
both audio and A/V productions.
CS-II is packed with other useful feature like dialog
clarity (SRS Dialog) for movies and cinema-like bass
enrichment (TruBass). CS-II can enable the dialog
to become clearer and more discernable in movies
and it enables the bass frequencies contained in the
original programming to more closely achieve low
frequencies–overcoming the low frequency limitations
of the speakers by full octave.
Circle Surround II, Dialog Clarity, TruBass, SRS and
symbol are trademarks of SRS Labs, Inc.
Circle Surround II , Dialog Clarity and TruBass
technology are incorporated under license from SRS
Labs, Inc.
HDCD® (High Definition Compatible Digital ®) is a
patented process for delivering on Compact Disc the full
richness and details of the original microphone feed.
HDCD encoded CDs sound better because they are
encoded with 20-bits of real musical information as
compared to 16-bits for all other CDs.
HDCD overcomes the limitation of the 16-bit CD
format by using a sophisticated system to encode
the additional four bits onto the CD while remaining
completely compatible with the CD format.
When listening to HDCD recordings, you hear more
dynamic range, a focused 3-D sound stage, and
extremely natural vocal and musical timbre. With
HDCD, you get the body, depth and emotion of the
original performance not a fl at, digital imitation.
HDCD system manufactured under license from
Microsoft. This product is covered by one or more
of the following: In the United States 5,479,168
5,638,074 5,640,161 5,808,574 5,838,274 5,854,600
5,864,311 5,872,531 and in Australia 669,114 with
other patents pending.
HDMI, the and High-Defi nition Multimedia
Interface are trademarks or registered trademarks of
HDMI Licensing LLC.
ENGLISH
5
ENGLISH
HD RadioTM technology is a new technology that
enables AM and FM radio stations to broadcast
programs digitally. Digital broadcasting provides
listeners with radically improved audio quality and
reception as well as new data services. Furthermore,
supplemental program services allow listeners to
select from up to 8 HD Radio programs multicast on
a single FM HD Radio channel. For more information
on HD RadioTM technology, visit “www.ibiquity.com”.
HD RadioTM Technology Manufactured Under License
From iBiquity Digital Corp. U.S. and Foreign Patents.
HD RadioTM and the HD Radio logo are proprietary
trademarks of iBiquity Digital Corp.
XM Satellite Radio Ready
The XM name and related logos are registered
trademarks of XM Satellite Radio Inc.
XM HD Surround uses Neural SurroundTM technology
to achieve optimal surround sound from XM radio.
There are several factors that can degrade the sound
from even the best loudspeakers in a listening room.
One of the most important is the interaction of sound
from the loudspeakers with large surfaces such as
walls, the fl oor, and the ceiling in the room. Even
with careful loudspeaker placement and acoustical
treatments, there are signifi cant problems that are
caused by room acoustics. These include refl ections
from nearby surfaces and standing waves that are
created between large parallel surfaces in the room.
In a home theater the situation is further complicated
because there are several listening locations. The
effects of room acoustics on the sound arriving at
each person’s ears are very different and the result is
a listening experience that is degraded in a different
way for every person in the room. It is not uncommon
to have variations in two adjacent seats that are as
large as 10 dB, particularly in the frequency range
below 250 Hz.
6
The solution to this problem is to apply room correction
after precisely measuring how each loudspeaker
interacts with the room. Because the room causes
variations in the frequency response of the
loudspeakers that are so large from seat to seat, it
is important to measure each loudspeaker at several
locations in the listening room. This should be done
even if there is only one listener. Measurement at a
single location is not representative of the acoustical
problems in the room and will in most cases, degrade
overall performance. Audyssey MultEQ is the only
technology that can achieve room correction for
multiple listeners in a large listening area. It does so
by combining the data collected at several points in
the room from each loudspeaker and then applying
correction that minimizes the acoustical effects of
the room and is matched to the frequency resolution
of human perception (known as psychoacoustics).
Furthermore, MultEQ correction is applied both
in frequency and time domains and so there are
no artifacts (such as smearing of sound or modal
ringing)that are sometimes associated with traditional
methods of room equalization.
In addition to correcting frequency response problems
over a wide listening area, Audyssey MultEQ provides
a completely automated sound system set-up
process. It identifi es how many loudspeakers are
connected to the amplifi ers and whether they are fullrange, satellites, or subwoofers. If there is a least one
subwoofer connected, Audyssey MultEQ determines
the optimum crossover frequency between each
satellite and the subwoofer(s). It automatically
checks the polarity of each loudspeaker and alerts
the user if there are any that may be wired outof-phase relative to the others. It measures the
distance to each loudspeaker from the main listening
position and adjusts the delays so that sound from
each loudspeaker arrives at the same time. Finally,
Audyssey MuitEQ determines the playback level of
each loudspeaker and adjusts the volume trims so
that all levels are equal.
MultEQ and the Audyssey MultEQ logo are
trademarks of Audyssey Laboratories, Inc. All rights
reserved.
BEFORE USE
This section must be read before any connection is
made to the mains supply.
EQUIPMENT MAINS WORKING SETTING
Your Marantz product has been prepared to comply
with the household power and safety requirements
that exist in your area.
SR7002/SR8002 can be powered by 120V AC only.
COPYRIGHT
Recording and playback of any material may
require consent. For further information refer to the
following:
— Copyright Act 1956
— Dramatic and Musical Performers Act 1958
— Performers Protection Acts 1963 and 1972
Any subsequent statutory enactments and orders
—
DO NOT LOCATE IN THE FOLLOWING PLACES
To ensure long-lasting use, do not locate the unit where:
• Exposed to direct sunlight.
• Near to sources of heat such as heaters.
• Highly humid or poorly ventilated.
• Dusty.
• Subjected to mechanical vibrations.
•
On wobbly, inclined or otherwise unstable surfaces
• Radiated heat is blocked such as in cramped
audio racks.
To ensure proper heat radiation, ensure the below
clearance from walls and other equipment.
Above
8 inchs (0.2 m)
Left
8 inchs (0.2 m)
or more
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8001
or more
PURE DIRECT
SURROUND
V-OFFDISPMULTI AUTO TUNED STSPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
SURRDIRECT
NIGHT
SLEEP
AUTO DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SLS SR
DSD
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
DOWN
MULTI
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
SPEAKER
MULTI
T-MODE
7.1CH INPUT
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
MultEQ
A/B
ENTER
MENU
EXIT
DIGITAL
MIC
VOLUME
AUX 1 INPUT
S-VIDEO
AUDIO
8 inchs (0.2 m)
UP
RLVIDEO
8 inchs (0.2 m)
or more
Right
or more
Rear
KEEP OBJECTS OFF
Keep objects off the unit. Blocking the vent can result
in accident and damage.
DO NOT TOUCH HOT SPOTS DURING AND
IMMEDIATELY AFTER USE
During and immediately after use, the unit is hot
in areas other than the controls and rear panel
connection jacks. Do not touch hot spots and
especially the top panel. Contact with hot areas can
cause burns.
Opening and closing the front panel door
When you want to use the controls behind
the front panel door, open the door by gently
pressing on the lower part of the panel. Keep the
door closed when not using these controls.
A
V
SU
I
N
RR
P
OUN
U
T
S
D
E
R
L
E
E
CE
C
T
IV
O
ER S
R
R
8001
D
I
S
S
TA
ND
B
Y
P
O
WE
R
O
N
/O
Caution:
• Be careful not to pinch your fi ngers between the
door and the panel.
P
M
S
U
L
L
E
T
E
I
P
A
U
A
T
U
O
T
O
S
T
U
U
R
N
R
E
F
F
D
D
I
R
S
E
T
C
T
S
P
K
R
D
I
A
S
C
B
6
.
1
V
O
F
M
F
T
X
P
6
E
.
1
A
K
A
N
IG
T
T
P
HON
ES
H
T
A
N
A
L
O
D
G
I
G
I
T
A
L
S
U
R
R
O
U
A
N
D
D
I
A
G
C
IT
A
L
L
P
C
M
C
R
L
F
E
S
L
S
S
R
V
O
L
U
M
E
NT
ER
E
D
O
WN
U
P
D
I
G
IT
A
L
S
V
A
ID
U
EO
X
1
I
NP
U
T
V
I
DE
O
L
A
U
D
I
O
R
OPERATION OF REMOTE CONTROLLER
REMOTE CONTROL
Operate the remote controller within a distance of
approx. 5m from the infrared receptor window on the
front of the unit.
SR7002/8002
A
V
S
U
INP
R
R
O
U
U
T SE
N
D
R
LE
E
C
CT
E
IV
O
E
R
R
S
R
8
0
0
1
D
I
S
P
STA
N
M
DBY
S
U
L
L
E
T
I
E
P
A
P
UT
O
A
U
W
O
T
E
O
R
S
T
U
O
U
R
N
N
R
/
E
O
D
F
D
F
I
R
S
E
T
C
T
S
P
K
R
D
I
A
S
C
B
6
.
1
V
O
F
F
M
T
X
P
6
E
.
1
A
K
A
N
T
I
G
T
H
P
T
HO
A
N
N
ES
A
L
O
D
G
I
G
I
T
A
L
S
UR
R
O
U
A
ND
D
IG
A
C
I
T
A
L
L
P
CM
C
R
L
FE
S
L
S
S
R
V
O
LU
M
E
E
NTER
DOW
Approx. 5 m
60°
O
FF
P
O
W
O
N
E
/
O
R
F
F
S
O
U
R
C
O
E
N
M
D
1
D
2
D
3
C
H
D
4
D
D
5
5
V
O
L
O
K
PR
EV
M
EN
T
U
E
S
T
1
G
U
I
D
7
.
E
1
C
H
C
H
4
M
.
S
U
E
L
D
T
IS
E
2
P
A
T
E
T
X
I
T
S
5
U
C
R
L
R
O
E
A
S
3
R
D
S
P
8
K-A
B
6
S
L
0
E
E
P
97
TV
M
E
M
O
T
U
N
E
D
R
VD
TA
P
E
C
D
VC
R
A
U
X
1
C
1
D
-
D
R
S
S
AU
LIGH
X
M
2
D
Le
T
ar
ni
n
R
g
C14
R
em
A
00
M
o
te Co
P
n
t
r
oller
2
Remote controller
Caution:
• Do not allow direct sunlight, an inverter fl uorescent
light or other strong source of light to shine onto
the player’s infrared receptor window. Otherwise,
the operation of the remote controller may be
disabled.
• Bear in mind that operating the remote controller
may cause other devices operated by infrared rays
to be operated by mistake.
• The remote controller cannot be operated if the
space between the controller and the player’s
infrared receptor window is obstructed.
• Do not place any objects on top of the remote
controller.
Doing so may cause one or more buttons to be
held down which will cause the batteries to run
down.
N
U
P
I
G
I
T
A
L
S
V
A
I
D
U
E
X
OD
1
I
N
P
U
T
V
I
D
E
O
L
A
U
D
I
O
R
LOADING BATTERIES
Before using the remote controller for the fi rst time,
load the batteries in the remote controller. The
batteries provided are used to verify the operations
of the remote controller only.
<RC8001SR>
Remove the back cover.
1.
2. Insert the new batteries (AAA type) with correct
ª and · polarity.
3. Close the battery cover until it clicks shut.
<RC101>
1. Remove the battery cover.
2. Insert the new batteries (AAA type) with correct
ª and · polarity.
3. Close the battery cover until it clicks shut.
CAUTIONS ON BATTERIES
• Use “AAA” type batteries in this remote controller.
• We recommend that you use alkali batteries.
• The life of the batteries used with the remote
controller is about 4 months with normal use.
• If the remote controller does not operate from
close to the unit, replace the batteries with new
ones, even if less then a year has passed.
• The included battery is only for verifying operation.
Replace it with a new battery as soon as possible.
• When inserting the batteries, be careful to do so in
the proper direction, following the + and - marks in
the remote controller’s battery compartment.
• To prevent damage or battery fl uid leakage:
- Do not use a new battery with an old one.
- Do not use two different types of batteries.
- Do not short-circuit, disassemble, heat or
dispose of batteries in fl ames.
• Remove the batteries when not planning to use the
remote controller for a long period of time.
• If the batteries should leak, carefully wipe off the
fl uid from the inside of the battery compartment,
then insert new batteries.
• When disposing of used batteries, please comply
with governmental regulations or environmental
public instruction’s rules that apply in your country
or area.
BATTERY REPLACEMENT INTERVAL (RC8001SR)
When the batteries wear out, a battery mark is
displayed on the LCD. Although the remote control
can still be used when the battery mark is displayed,
the batteries should be replaced as soon as possible.
The LCD eventually starts to fl ash when buttons are
pressed, the remote control will be unable to transmit
signals or learn codes.
• This remote control uses non-volatile memory so
that the learned codes and macro programs are
retained even if the batteries are removed.
• Reset the clock after replacing the batteries.
ENGLISH
7
ENGLISH
NAMES AND FUNCTION
FRONT PANEL
qty ur!2!3!4ew
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
PURE DIRECT
M-DAX
SURROUND
STANDBY
POWER ON/STANDBY
PHONES
PURE DIRECT THX
@4 @3 @2!8!6
q
POWER switch and STANDBY indicator
When this switch is pressed once, the unit turns ON
and the display illuminates. When pressed again, the
unit turns OFF and the STANDBY indicator will be
illuminated.
w INPUT SELECTOR knob
(AUDIO/ VIDEO)
This knob is used to select the input sources. (See
page 58)
e
HEADPHONE jack for stereo headphones
This jack may be used to listen to the unit’s output
through a pair of headphones. Be certain that the
headphones have a standard 1/4” stereo phono
plug.
r SURROUND MODE button
Press this button to select the surround mode.
t AUTO (Auto surround) button
Press this button to select the AUTO mode from the
surround modes. When this mode is selected, the
unit determines the surround mode corresponding to
a digital input signal automatically.
MODE AUTO
SLEEP
AUTO
MULTI
SURR DIRECT
7.1CH INPUT
@1!9@0
MULTI
SPEAKER
MENU
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1EQ
io!0!1
VOLUME
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
ENTER
SURROUND
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
NIGHT
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
EXIT
A/B
MIC
!7
!5
DOWN
AUX 1 INPUT
DIGITAL
S-VIDEO
UP
RLVIDEO
AUDIO
y MULTI (Multi Room) button
Press this button to activate the Multiroom system.
“MULTI” indicator will be illuminated in the display.
(See page 78)
u MULTI SPEAKER button
Press this button to activate the Multiroom Speaker
system. “MULTI” indicator will be illuminated in the
display.
(See page 78)
i BAND button
Press this button to switch between FM, AM and XM
(XM Ready) in the TUNER mode.
o T-MODE button
Press this button to select the auto stereo mode or
mono mode when the FM band is selected.
The “AUTO” indicator lights in the auto stereo mode.
(See page 68)
!0 MEMORY button
Press this button to enter the tuner preset memory
numbers or station names. (See page 68)
!1 CLEAR button
Press this button to cancel the station-memory
setting mode or preset scan tuning. (See page 69)
!2
INFRARED receiving sensor window
This window receives infrared signals for the remote
controller.
!3 VOLUME control knob
This knob is used to adjust the overall sound level.
Turning the control clockwise increases the sound
level.
!4 AUX1 INPUT jacks
These auxiliary video/audio input jacks accept the
connections of a camcorder, portable DVD, game
etc. When not using these jacks, protect with the
included jack covers.
How to Attach the Front AUX Jack Cover
U
P
D
IG
ITA
L
S-VIDEO
AUX
1 IN
PU
T
VID
EO
L
AUD
IO
R
PUSH
PUSH
Front AUX Jack Cover
!5 M-DAX button
Press this button to select M-DAX processing for
input source. (See page 59)
!6 SPEAKER A/B button
Press this button to select speaker systems A and/or
B.
!7 MIC jack
Automatically measure speaker characteristics using
the included microphone. (See page 46)
!8 DISPLAY button
Press this button to change the FL display mode.
!9 EXIT button
Press this button to exit from the SETUP MAIN
MENU.
@0
Cursor (
Press these buttons to operate the SETUP MAIN
MENU and TUNER function.
5, ∞, 2, 3
) / ENTER button
@1 MENU button
Press this button to enter the SETUP MAIN MENU.
@2 7.1CH INPUT button
Press this button to select the output of an external
multichannel player.
@3 THX button
Press this button to select THX processing for input
source.
@4
PURE DIRECT button and indicator
When this button is pressed once, “SOURCE
DIRECT” appears on the FL display. If pressed again,
“PURE DIRECT” appears. After 2 seconds, the FL
display indication goes out.
In the source/pure direct mode, the tone control
circuitry and bass management are bypassed.
Notes:
• The surround mode is automatically switched to
AUTO when the pure direct function is turned on.
• Additionally, speaker configurations are fixed
automatically as follows.
Front SPKR = LARGE
Center SPKR = LARGE
Surround SPKR = LARGE
Surround Back SPKR = LARGE
Sub woofer = YES
8
FL DISPLAY AND INDICATER
M-DAX
¡
™
¡
¡
™
¡
™
s
a
DISP MULTI AUTOTUNED ST V – OFF NIGHT PEAKANALOG
AUTO
SURR
SLEEP
M-DAX
hk¡0 ¡2¡4f
g
jl¡1
DISC 6.1DIRECTMTX 6.1 SPKR AB
ATT
96/24
This indicator is illuminated when a DTS 96/24 signal
is input.
¡3
DIGITAL
EQ
PCM
¡5d
SURROUND
DIGITAL
LCR
LFE
SL S SR
PCM
This indicator is illuminated when the input signal is
PCM (pulse code modulation).
2 SURROUND
This indicator is illuminated when a Dolby Surround
signal is input.
™2 PURE DIRECT indicator
This indicator is illuminated when this unit is in the
PURE DIRECT mode.
ENGLISH
1
2
0
9
a DISP (Display Off) indicator
This indicator is illuminated when this unit is in the
display off mode.
s SLEEP timer indicator
This indicator is illuminated when the sleep timer
function in the main-room is in use.
d Multi-room system indicator
This indicator is illuminated when the multi-room
system is active.
f AUTO SURR
(Auto Surround mode) indicator
This indicator is illuminated to show that the AUTO
SURROUND mode is in use.
g TUNER’s indicators
AUTO : This indicator illuminates when the
TUNED : This indicator illuminates when the
ST(Stereo) : This indicator illuminates when an
tuner’s Auto mode is in use.
tuner receives a suffi ciently strong
radio signal.
FM station is being tuned into stereo
condition.
8
7
6
l SPKR (speaker) AB indicator
This indicator is illuminated when the speaker
system is active.
¡0 PEAK indicator
This indicator is a monitor for an analog audio input
signal. If the selected analog audio input signal is
greater than the capable level of internal processing,
this will illuminate. If this happens, you should press
the ATT button. (See page 11)
¡1 EQ indicator
This indicator is illuminated when the EQ MODE is
selected to “AUDDYSSEY”, “FRONT” or “FLAT”.
¡2 ATT (Attenuation) indicator
This indicator is illuminated when the attenuation
function is active.
¡3 DIGITAL Input Indicator
This indicator is illuminated when a digital input has
been selected.
¡4 ANALOG input indicator
This indicator is illuminated when an analog input
source has been selected.
¡6 HDMI indicator
This indicator is illuminated when the HDMI device is
connected to the unit.
¡7
ENCODED CHANNEL STATUS indicators
These indicators display the channels that are
encoded with a digital
input signal.
If the digital input signal is Dolby Digital 5.1ch or
DTS 5.1ch, “L”, “C”, “R”, “SL”, “SR” and “LFE” will be
illuminated.
If the digital input signal is 2 channel PCM-audio, “L”
and “R” will be illuminated.
If the digital input signal is 7.1channel PCM-Audio.
“L”, “C”, “R”, “SL”, “S” , “SR” and “LFE” will be
illuminated.
If the digital input signal is Dolby Digital 5.1ch signal
with Surround EX fl ag or DTS-ES, “L”, “C”, “R”, “SL”,
“S” , “SR” and “LFE” will be illuminated.
Note:
When this unit is decoding a Dolby True HD signal,
the status of the input signal is displayed, depending
on the number of speaker channels being used.
The “S” indicator is not illuminated when a 7.1channel signal is input to a 5.1-channel speaker system
with L, C, R, SL, SR, and SW.
¡8 HDCD indicator
This indicator is illuminated when the HDCD signal is
decoded from digital input signal.
h
DTS-ES mode indicators (DISC6.1, MTX6.1)
These indicators will illuminate to show the DTS-ES
decoding mode (Discrete 6.1 or Matrix 6.1).
j V (video)-OFF mode indicator
This indicator is illuminated when the Video-OFF
function is active.
k NIGHT mode indicator
This indicator is illuminated when this unit is in the
Night mode, which reduces the dynamic range of
digital program material at low volume levels.
¡5 SIGNAL FORMAT indicators
2DIGITAL
This indicator is illuminated when a Dolby Digital
signal is input.
EX
This indicator is illuminated when a Dolby Digital EX
signal is input.
dts
This indicator is illuminated when a DTS signal is
input.
ES
This indicator is illuminated when a DTS ES signal
is input.
¡9 Main Information Display
This display shows messages relating to the status,
input source, surround mode, tuner, volume level or
other aspects of unit’s operation.
™0 SOURCE DIRECT indicator
This indicator is illuminated when this unit is in the
SOURCE DIRECT mode.
™1 M-DAX indicator
This indicator illuminates when this unit is in the MDAX mode.
9
ENGLISH
HDMI
Ver1.3
REMOTE
MULTI RC
REAR PANEL
@4
@3
@2
y XM terminal
See page 37 for connecting information.
e
rqwuit y
u Sub Speaker outputs terminals
(MULTI SPEAKER / SPEAKER C)
Two terminals are provided for the front left, and right
speakers for multi room.
The terminals can be used to connect a third set of
speakers by setting the SPEAKER C selector switch
to ON. For connection and use, see page 38.
HDMI
Ver1.3
i Speaker outputs terminals
REMOTE
MULTI RC
Nine terminals are provided for the front (A) left, front
(A) right, front (B) left, front (B) right, front center,
surround left, surround right, surround back left and
surround back right speakers.
!2 Preamp Outputs
(L, R, SL, SR, SBL, SBR, C)
Jacks for L (front left), R (front right), C (Center), SL
(surround left), SR (surround right), SBL (surround
back left) and SBR (surround back right).
Use these jacks for connection to external power
amplifi ers.
!3 Subwoofer Output
Connect this jack to the line level input of a powered
subwoofer. If an external subwoofer amplifi er is used,
connect this jack to the subwoofer amplifi er input.
If you are using two subwoofers, either powered or
with a 2 channel subwoofer amplifi er, connect a “Y”
connector to the subwoofer output jack and run one
cable from it to each subwoofer amplifi er.
@1
!9@0
!8!7 !6
q FM antenna terminal (75 ohms)
Connect an external FM antenna with a coaxial
cable, or a cable network FM source.
AM antenna and ground terminals
Connect the supplied AM loop antenna. Use the
terminals marked “AM” and “GND”. The supplied AM
loop antenna will provide good AM reception in most
areas. Position the loop antenna until you hear the
best reception.
Note:
• The SR8002 can receive HD Radio broadcasts. (See
p.70)
w COMPONENT VIDEO INPUT/
OUTPUT
If your DVD player or other device has component
video connectors, be sure to connect them to these
component video connectors on the unit. This unit
has 4 component video input connectors to obtain
the color information (Y, CB, CR) directly from the
recorded DVD signal or other video component and
two component video outputs connector to output it
directly into the matrix decoder of the display device.
By sending the pure DVD component video signal
directly, the DVD signal forgoes the extra processing
that normally would degrade the image. The result is
vastly increased image quality, with incredibly life like
colors and crisp detail.
10
e
!5!3
!0!1!2!4
o
e Multiroom Outputs
(Audio output A/B, Video)
These are the audio and video output jacks for the
Multi zone (Multi room).
Connect these jacks to optional audio power
amplifi ers or video display devices to listen and view
the source selected by the multiroom system in a
remote room.
Note:
• The SR7002 does not use Multiroom audio output
B.
r MONITOR OUT
These are monitor outputs and each one includes
both composite video and S-video confi gurations.
When connecting two video monitors or televisions,
be aware that the OSD interface can be used with
both MONITOR OUT connections.
t RS-232C
The RS-232C port is to be used in conjunction with
an external controller to control the operation of the
unit by using an external device.
The RS-232C port may also be used in the future to
update the operating software of the unit so that it will
be able to support new digital audio formats and the
like as they are introduced.
o SPEAKER C switch
Set to ON to connect a bi-amp to this receiver or set
to OFF for normal speaker connection (surround
back and multiroom speakers). (See page 38)
!0 AC OUTLETS
Connect the AC power cables of components such as
a DVD and CD player to these outlets. SWITCHED and
UNSWITCHED outlets are provided.
The one marked SWITCHED provides power
only when the unit is turned on and is useful for
components which you use every time you play your
system.
The one marked UNSWITCHED is always live as
long as the unit is plugged into a live outlet.
A component connected here may be left on
permanently, or may be switched off with via its own
power switch.
Caution:
• In order to avoid potential turn-off thumps, anything
plugged into these outlets should be powered up
before the unit is turned on.
• The capacity of this AC outlet is 150W. Do not
connect devices that consume electricity more than
the capacity of these AC outlets. If the total power
consumption of the connected devices exceeds the
capacity, the protection circuit shuts down the power
supply.
!1 AC INLET
Plug the supplied power cord into this AC INLET and
then into the power outlet on the wall.
This unit can be powered by 120V AC only.
!4 7.1 CHANNEL or AUX2 INPUT
By connecting a DVD Audio player, Super Audio CD
multichannel player, or other components that has a
multichannel port, you can playback the audio with
5.1 channel or 7.1 channel outputs.
!5 EMITTER OUT (SR8002 only)
The signals input to the IR RECEIVER IN terminals
are output to this terminal. External devices can be
controlled by connecting them to this terminal.
!6 IR RECEIVER IN (SR8002 only)
Connect to an external IR receiver.
!7
FLASHER IN (Flasher input terminal)
These terminals are to control the unit from each zone.
Connect the control signal from a Keypad, etc.
!8 DC TRIGGER output terminal
Connect a device that needs to be triggered by DC
under certain conditions (screen, power strip, etc…)
Use the system OSD setup menu to determine the
conditions by which these jack will be active.
Note:
• This output voltage is for (status) control only, It is
not suffi cient for drive capability.
!9
MULTI ROOM REMOTE IN/OUT terminals
IN: Connect to a multi-room remote control
device, available from your Marantz dealer.
OUT: Connect to the Marantz component equipped
with remote control (RC-5) terminals in Multi
zone (Multi room).
@0 REMOTE CONT. IN/OUT terminals
Connect to a Marantz component equipped with
remote control (RC-5) terminals.
@1 AUDIO IN/OUT (TV, DVD, VCR1,
DSS/VCR2, TAPE, CD/CDR)
These are the analog audio inputs and outputs.
There are 6 audio inputs and 4 audio outputs. The
audio jacks are nominally labeled for cassette tape
decks, compact disc players, DVD players and etc....
The audio inputs and outputs require RCA-type
connectors.
@2 DIGITAL INPUT (Dig.1 - 6) /
OUTPUT (coaxial, optical)
These are the digital audio inputs and outputs. There
are 3 digital inputs with coaxial jacks, 3 with optical
jacks.
The inputs accept digital audio signals from a
compact disc, LD, DVD, or other digital source
component.
For digital output, there is 1 coaxial output and 1
optical output.
The digital outputs can be connected to MD
recorders, CD recorders, DAT decks, or other similar
components.
@3
VIDEO IN/OUT
(TV, DVD, VCR1, DSS/VCR2)
These are the video inputs and outputs. There
are 4 video inputs and 2 video outputs and each
one includes both composite video and S-video
confi gurations. Connect VCRs, DVD players, and
other video components to the video inputs.
The 2 video output channels can be used to be
connected to video tape recorders for making
recordings.
@4 HDMI INPUT / OUTPUT
This unit has 4 HDMI inputs and 2 HDMI output. The
input function can be selected from the OSD menu
system. (See page 43)
REMOTE CONTROL
OPERATION (RC8001SR)
NAME AND FUNCTION
The provided remote controller is a universal
remote controller. The POWER button, numeric
buttons and control buttons are used in common
across different input source components.
The input source controlled with the remote controller
changes when one of the input selector buttons is
pressed.
z
POWER
¤1
¤0
⁄9
⁄8
⁄7
OFF
CH
PREV
MENU
TEST
7.1CH
DISP
CLEAR
TV
TUNER
CD
AUX1
TAP E
12
Learning Remote Controller
ON/OFF
SOURCE
OK
LIP·SYNC
GUIDE
CH.SEL
ATT
OSD
THX
LIGHT
RC8001SR
ON
M
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D5
x
c
v
b
n
VOL
m
MUTE
EXIT
SURR
231
SPK-AB
564
SLEEP
8
97
MEMO
0
,
.
⁄0
⁄1
⁄2⁄6
⁄3
DSS
VCRDVD
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
⁄4
⁄5
z Infrared Transmitter and Learning
Sensor
This transmitter emits infrared light. Press the buttons
while pointing the transmitter towards the infrared
receiver window of the unit or other AV equipment.
Be sure to also point towards other remote controls
when using the learning function.
x POWER ON and OFF buttons
(When AMP mode is selected)
These buttons are used to turn the unit on or off.
c SOURCE ON/OFF button
This button is used to turn a specifi c source (such as
a DVD player) on or off independently from the rest
of the system.
v M (Mode) button
This button is used to program Macros. Pressing this
button switches between Normal mode and Macro
mode.
The > button is used to move to the next page. Up to
20 programs (4 pages) can be made. Holding down
the M button for three seconds or more switches to
the Setup mode, where the Setup menu is shown on
the LCD. The Setup menu has four pages, and the >
button is used to move to the next page. Pressing the
> button from page 4 returns you to page 1.
b D1 to D5 (Direct) buttons
Five types of direct operations can be performed
for each of the 12 source buttons such as the DVD,
television, amplifi er, and other AV equipment. The
pages can be switched, so 4 pages × 5 types = 20
operations can be performed for a single source. The
text display can also be changed.
n > (Page) button
This button is used to switch pages for the Direct
button. The current page is shown on the LCD.
m VOL (Volume) button
This button is used to adjust the volume for the
amplifi er and television.
Note:
• Set the AMP mode to use this button with the unit.
, MUTE button
This button is used to mute the audio for the amplifi er
and television.
Note:
• Set the AMP mode to use this button with the unit.
. GUIDE button
This button is used to display the menus for the DVD
player, DSS (satellite broadcasting tuner), or other
AV equipment.
(when AMP mode is selected)
This button is used to select the LIP.SYNC mode.
⁄0 EXIT button
(when AMP mode is selected)
This button is used to cancel settings in the setup
menu.
⁄1 Numeric buttons
These buttons are used to switch between 0 to 9
of the source components. If the source is set to
the amplifier, these buttons are used to perform
operations.
(when AMP mode is selected)
(1) TEST button
This button is used to enter the test tone menu.
(2) CH SEL. (channel select) button
This button is used to call up SETUP MAIN MENU
and adjust speaker levels or 7.1 ch input level.
(3) SURR (surround) button
This button is used to select the surround mode.
(4) 7.1CH button
This button is used to select the output of an external
multi channel decoder.
(5) ATT button
When the input signal is too high and the voice
distorts even by throttling the unit VOLUME control,
turn on this function. “ATT” is indicated when this
function is activated.
The input level is reduced. Attenuator is invalid for
use with the output signal of “REC OUT”.
Note:
• This function is unavailable during the digital input
is selected.
(6) SPK-AB button
Speaker mode is switched in the following
sequence.
A → B → A+B → off
ENGLISH
11
ENGLISH
(7) DISP. button
Selects the display mode for the front display of the
unit.
(8) OSD button
When this button is pressed, the current setting are
displayed on the TV monitor.
(9) SLEEP (sleep timer) button
This button is used for setting the sleep timer.
Each time this button is pressed, the sleep timer
is increased by 10 minutes, in a range of 10–120
minutes.
(0) THX button
Use this button to select the THX mode.
⁄2 MEMO button
This button is used to store settings to memory or
program a source.
⁄3 CONTROL button
Thses buttons are used when operating the PLAY,
STOP, PAUSE, and other commands of a source.
Note:
• This button is unavailable for the unit.
⁄7 MENU button
(when AMP mode is selected)
This button is used to call up the SETUP MAIN
MENU of the unit.
⁄8 PREV (Previous) button
This button is used to return to the previous channel
on the television or other device.
Note:
• This button is unavailable for the unit.
⁄9 CH (Channel) button
This is used to change channels.
¤0 CURSOR buttons
These buttons are used when controlling the cursor
of the unit, DVD, or other AV equipment.
¤1 LCD
Information about the sources and modes are shown
on the LCD.
LCD INDICATORS (RC8001SR)
Information about currently selected source and
direct code names are displayed on the LCD.
A
J
I
H
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
B
G
F
E
USE
PAGE
123
4
C
D
A Source Name indicator
This displays the name of the selected source, such
as DVD, television, or other AV equipment (up to fi ve
characters).
H MACRO indicator
This indicator is displayed when the remote controller
is in macro programming mode.
I NAME indicator
This indicator is displayed when the remote controller
is in renaming mode.
J LEARN indicator
This indicator is displayed when the remote controller
is in learning mode.
⁄4 SOURCE button
Thses buttons are used to switch the source of your
A/V Receiver / amplifer. Each time a source button is
pressed, the remote controller changes to the source
which was pressed.
This remote controller can control 12 types of
equipment. To change the A/V Receiver / amplifi er
source, press this button twice within two seconds.
The signal is sent when it is pressed the second
time.
Note:
• Select the AMP as the source to use this remote
controller with the unit.
• The MD button does not work with the unit.
⁄5 LIGHT 1 and 2 buttons
Pressing these buttons will light up the LCD and its
buttons. This lighting time can be set. If the lighting
time is set to 0 seconds, the backlight turns on only
while this button is pressed. The operations for
LIGHT 1 and 2 are identical.
⁄6 CLEAR button
This button is used to erase the memory or program
of a source.
12
B Direct Button Name indicator
This displays up to 20 types of button names for each
source. (up to six characters)
C Page indicator
This displays the current page position.
D Transmission indicator
This indicator is displayed when the remote controller
is sending a signal.
E USE indicator
This indicator is displayed under normal operation.
F Battery Level indicator
This indicator is displayed when the battery level is
low.
G TIMER indicator
This indicator is displayed when the macro timer is
set.
SETTING THE TIME
Example: Setting to 6:20PM (18:20)
1 2
POWER
OFF
ON/OFF
ON
SOURCE
CH
OK
OK
LIP.SYNC
PREV
GUIDE
MENU
TEST
CH.SEL
7.1CH
ATT
DISP
OSD
THX
CLEAR
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
AUX1
TAPE
LIGHT
12
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
When you bought this remote controller and insert
the batteries to the remote controller at fi rst, the steps
1 to 3 are skipped.
Starts from step 4 to set the time.
1.
M
M
D1
D2
D3
3.
D4
D4
D5
D5
2.
VOL
6.
MUTE
EXIT
SURR
4.
231
21
SPK-AB
564
5.
SLEEP
8097
8
MEMO
0
DSS
VCRDVD
MD
AMP
AUX2
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
1 23
3 4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
5 6
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
4
4
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
Whenever the batteries are replaced, the clock
shows 00:00. Please reset the clock. (The time
setting is not backed up.)
CHECKING THE TIME
To check the time, hold down the > button for three
seconds or more. The current time is displayed for
fi ve seconds.
Note:
• Although the remote controller uses a quartz clock,
the time may become out of sync over the course of
operation. Be sure to correct the clock from time to
time.
GENERAL INFORMATION OF RC8001SR TO THE UNIT
To control the unit by your RC8001SR, you have to select the device AMP or TUNER by pressing the function
selector button. Please refer below for the details in AMP and TUNER mode.
AMP MODE
TUNERCDCD-R
TUNERCDCD-R
TAPE
TAPE
TUNER MODE
POWER
POWER
OFF
ON/OFF
ON
OFF
ON/OFF
ON
SOURCE
SOURCE
M
D1
D1
D2
D2
LEARN
NAME
D3
D3
D4
D4
USE
PAGE
123
4
D5
D5
D5
D5
CH
CLEAR
TV
TV
VOL
VOL
OK
OK
LIP.SYNC
PREV
MUTE
MUTE
GUIDE
MENU
EXIT
MENU
EXIT
TEST
CH.SEL
SURR
TEST
CH.SEL
SURR
231
231
7.1CH
ATT
SPK-AB
7.1CH
ATT
SPK-AB
564
564
DISP
OSD
SLEEP
DISP
OSD
SLEEP
97
8
897
THX
MEMO
0
DSS
DSS
VCRDVD
VCRDVD
MD
MD
AMP
AUX2
AUX1
AUX2
AUX1
AMP
LIGHT
12
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
SOURCE ON/OFFTurns the SR7002/SR8002 on and off
POWER ONTurns the SR7002/SR8002 on
POWER OFFTurns the SR7002/SR8002 off
D1 - D5 / >(Page)(Refer to page vi)
VOL +/-Adjust the over all sound level
MUTEDecreases the sound temporarily
CursorMove the cursor for setting in SETUP MENU mode
OKEnter the SETUP MENU
Confi rms the setting in SETUP MENU mode
MENUEnter the SETUP MENU
EXITExits from SETUP MENU
TEST (1)Enter the test tone menu
CH.SEL (2)Call up SETUP MENU and adjusts speaker levels or 7.1ch
input setup
SURR (3)Selects the surround mode
7.1CH (4)Selects the 7.1CH IN
ATT (5)Reduces the input level
SPK-AB (6)Selects the speaker system
DISP (7)Changes the front display mode
OSD (8)Displays the current setting on the monitor
SLEEP (9)Sets the sleep timer function
THX (0)Selects the THX mode
Function selectorSelects a particular source component
GUIDE / LIP.SYNCSelects the LIP.SYNC mode
ENGLISH
Hold down the M button for three seconds or
1.
more.
The menu is displayed.
2. Press the > button once.
This displays second page (SETUP).
3. Press the D4 (CLOCK) direct button.
The “ ” indicator blinks and the clock indicator
displays “0:00”.
4. Press the 1 and 8 numeric button to set the
hour indicator.
The hour indicator displays “18”.
The minute indicator blinks “_”.
5. Press the 2 and 0 numeric button to set the
minute indicator.
The minute indicator displays “20”.
The hour indicator blinks.
6. Press the OK cursor button to start the clock.
The clock starts from 0 second at the time that was
set and return to normal (USE) mode.
POWER
OFF
ON/OFF
ON
SOURCE
M
D1
D1
D2
D2
D3
D3
D4
D4
USE
PAGE
1
D5
D5
D5
D5
VOL
CH
CH
OK
LIP.SYNC
PREV
MUTE
GUIDE
GUIDE
MENU
EXIT
TEST
CH.SEL
SURR
TEST
CH.SEL
SURR
231
231
7.1CH
ATT
SPK-AB
7.1CH
ATT
SPK-AB
564
564
DISP
OSD
SLEEP
DISP
OSD
SLEEP
8097
897
THX
MEMO
CLEAR
MEMO
CLEAR
0
DSS
VCRDVD
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
TUNER
TAPE
MD
AMP
AUX2
AUX1
LIGHT
12
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
D1 - D5 / >(Page)(Refer to page vi)
CH +/-Selects a preset station up and down
GUIDESelects the “Frequency direct input”
0–9Input the numeric
MEMOEnter the tuner preset memory numbers
CLEARClears the inputting
TUNERSelects a frequency band
13
ENGLISH
CONTROLLING MARANTZ COMPONENTS
1. Press the desired function button.
• The selected function name and USE are displayed in the LCD.
Press the desired operation buttons to play the selected component.
2.
• For details, refer to the component’s user guide.
• It may not be possible to operate some models.
CONTROLLING A MARANTZ DVD PLAYER (DVD MODE)
POWER
POWER
OFF
ON/OFF
USE
DVD
AUX1
Learning Remote Controller
ON
ON/OFF
ON
SOURCE
SOURCE
M
D1
D1
D2
D2
D3
D3
D4
D4
PAGE
1
D5
D5
D5
D5
VOL
OK
OK
LIP.SYNC
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
CH.SEL
SURR
231
231
ATT
SPK-AB
ATT
SPK-AB
564
564
OSD
SLEEP
OSD
SLEEP
8097
8097
THX
MEMO
MEMO
DSS
VCRDVD
MD
AMP
AUX2
LIGHT
RC8001SR
OFF
CH
PREV
MENU
MENU
TEST
TEST
7.1CH
7.1CH
DISP
DISP
CLEAR
CLEAR
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
TAPE
12
SOURCE ON/OFF
POWER ONTurns the DVD player on
POWER OFFTurns the DVD player off
D1 - D5 / >(Page) (Refer to page vi)
Cursor/OKMove the cursor, enters the setting
MENUCalls up the menu of DVD disc
0-9Input the numeric
MEMOCall up the programming menu
CLEARClears the inputting
2
4 / ¢Skip forward or previous chapter/
9
;
Turns the DVD player on and off
Play
track
Stop
Pause
CONTROLLING A MARANTZ CD PLAYER (CD MODE)
POWER
POWER
OFF
ON/OFF
USE
CD
AUX1
Learning Remote Controller
ON
ON/OFF
ON
SOURCE
SOURCE
M
D1
D1
D2
D2
D3
D3
D4
D4
PAGE
1
D5
D5
D5
D5
VOL
OK
LIP.SYNC
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
CH.SEL
SURR
231
231
ATT
SPK-AB
ATT
SPK-AB
564
564
OSD
SLEEP
OSD
SLEEP
8097
8097
THX
MEMO
MEMO
DSS
VCRDVD
MD
AMP
AUX2
LIGHT
RC8001SR
OFF
CH
PREV
MENU
MENU
TEST
TEST
7.1CH
7.1CH
DISP
DISP
CLEAR
CLEAR
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
TAPE
12
SOURCE ON/OFF
POWER ONTurns the CD player on
POWER OFFTurns the CD player off
D1 - D5 / >(Page) (Refer to page vi)
MENUSwitches the display information
0-9Input the numeric
MEMOPrograms
CLEARClears the inputting
2
4 / ¢Skip forward or previous track
9
;
Turns the CD player on and off
Play
Stop
Pause
14
ENGLISH
CONTROLLING A MARANTZ VCR (VCR MODE)
POWER
POWER
OFF
ON/OFF
ON
ON/OFF
SOURCE
SOURCE
M
D1
D1
D2
D2
D3
D3
D4
PAGE
1
OK
LIP.SYNC
GUIDE
CH.SEL
CH.SEL
231
231
ATT
ATT
564
564
OSD
OSD
8097
8
THX
0
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
D4
D5
D5
D5
D5
VOL
MUTE
EXIT
EXIT
SURR
SURR
SPK-AB
SPK-AB
SLEEP
SLEEP
97
MEMO
DSS
VCRDVD
VCR
MD
AMP
AUX2
USE
CH
PREV
MENU
MENU
TEST
7.1CH
7.1CH
DISP
DISP
CLEAR
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
TAPE
12
SOURCE ON/OFF
D1 - D5 / >(Page) (Refer to page vi)
MENUCall up the menu
EXITExits the programming menu
0-9Input the numeric
2
4 / ¢Skip forward or previous track
9
;
0
Turns the VCR on and off
Play
Stop
Pause
Record
CONTROLLING A MARANTZ CD RECORDER (CDR MODE)
POWER
POWER
OFF
ON/OFF
USE
AUX1
Learning Remote Controller
ON
ON/OFF
ON
SOURCE
SOURCE
M
D1
D1
D2
D2
D3
D3
D4
D4
PAGE
1
D5
D5
D5
D5
VOL
OK
LIP.SYNC
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
CH.SEL
SURR
231
231
ATT
SPK-AB
ATT
SPK-AB
564
564
OSD
SLEEP
OSD
SLEEP
8097
8097
THX
MEMO
MEMO
DSS
VCRDVD
MD
CD-R
AMP
AUX2
LIGHT
RC8001SR
OFF
CH
PREV
MENU
MENU
TEST
TEST
7.1CH
7.1CH
DISP
DISP
CLEAR
CLEAR
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
TAPE
12
SOURCE ON/OFF
POWER ONTurns the CD recorder on
POWER OFFTurns the CD recorder off
D1 - D5 / >(Page) (Refer to page vi)
MENUSwitches the display information
0-9Input the numeric
MEMOPrograms
CLEARClears the inputting
2
4 / ¢Skip forward or previous track
9
;
0
Turns the CD recorder on and off
Play
Stop
Pause
Record
CONTROLLING A MARANTZ MD DECK (MD MODE)
POWER
POWER
OFF
ON/OFF
USE
AUX1
Learning Remote Controller
ON
ON/OFF
ON
SOURCE
SOURCE
M
D1
D1
D2
D2
D3
D3
D4
D4
PAGE
1
D5
D5
D5
D5
VOL
OK
LIP.SYNC
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
231
231
ATT
SPK-AB
564
564
OSD
SLEEP
8097
8097
THX
MEMO
MEMO
DSS
VCRDVD
MD
MD
AMP
AUX2
LIGHT
RC8001SR
OFF
CH
PREV
MENU
MENU
TEST
7.1CH
DISP
CLEAR
CLEAR
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
TAPE
12
SOURCE ON/OFF
POWER ONTurns the MD deck on
POWER OFFTurns the MD deck off
D1 - D5 / >(Page) (Refer to page vi)
MENUSwitches the display information
0-9Input the numeric
MEMOPrograms
CLEARClears the inputting
2
4 / ¢Skip forward or previous track
9
;
0
Turns the MD deck on and off
Play
Stop
Pause
Record
15
ENGLISH
CONTROLLING A MARANTZ TAPE DECK (TAPE MODE)
POWER
POWER
OFF
ON/OFF
USE
AUX1
Learning Remote Controller
ON
ON/OFF
ON
SOURCE
SOURCE
M
D1
D1
D2
D2
D3
D3
D4
D4
PAGE
1
D5
D5
D5
D5
VOL
OK
LIP.SYNC
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
CH.SEL
SURR
231
231
ATT
SPK-AB
ATT
SPK-AB
564
564
OSD
SLEEP
OSD
SLEEP
97
8097
8
THX
MEMO
MEMO
0
DSS
VCRDVD
MD
AMP
AUX2
LIGHT
RC8001SR
OFF
CH
PREV
MENU
TEST
7.1CH
7.1CH
DISP
DISP
CLEAR
CLEAR
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
TAPE
TAPE
12
SOURCE ON/OFF
POWER ONTurns the TAPE deck on
POWER OFFTurns the TAPE deck off
D1 - D5 / >(Page) (Refer to page vi)
0-9Input the numeric
MEMOPrograms
CLEARClears the inputting
2
4 / ¢Skip forward or previous track
9
;
0
Turns the TAPE deck on and off
Play
Stop
Pause
Record
CONTROLLING A MARANTZ UNIVERSAL DOCK (AUX1 MODE)
Turns the UNIVERSAL DOCK
(Dock connector) ON and OFF
Turns the UNIVERSAL DOCK
(Dock connector) ON
Turns the UNIVERSAL DOCK
(Dock connector) OFF
Play / Pause
Stop
Pause
POWER
POWER
OFF
ON/OFF
USE
AUX1
Learning Remote Controller
ON
ON/OFF
ON
SOURCE
SOURCE
M
D1
D1
D2
D2
D3
D3
D4
D4
PAGE
1
D5
D5
D5
D5
VOL
OK
LIP.SYNC
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
CH.SEL
SURR
231
231
ATT
SPK-AB
ATT
SPK-AB
564
564
OSD
SLEEP
OSD
SLEEP
97
8097
8
THX
MEMO
MEMO
0
DSS
VCRDVD
MD
AMP
AUX2
LIGHT
RC8001SR
OFF
CH
PREV
MENU
TEST
7.1CH
7.1CH
DISP
DISP
CLEAR
CLEAR
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
TAPE
TAPE
12
SOURCE ON/OFF
POWER ON
POWER OFF
D1 - D5 / >(Page) (Refer to page vi)
MENUCall up the menu
Cursor UpSelect contents Up
Cursor DownSelect contents Down
OKEnter the setting
2
4 / ¢Next track / previous track
9
;
16
BASIC OPERATION
USE MODE
(Normal operation status)
This remote controller is preset with a total of
12 types of remote codes, including Marantz TV
(television), DVD, VCR (VCR deck), DSS (satellite
broadcasting tuner), TUNER, CD/CD-R, MD, TAPE
(tape deck), AUX1, AUX2, and AMP (amplifi er).
Learning is not necessary for Marantz products. You
can use these products without setting any codes.
Press the SOURCE button.
1.
For this example, press DVD.
DVD is shown on the LCD, and the remote controller
is set for DVD.
Pressing the
remote control to the settings for the source that
was pressed.
To change the amplifi er or other source, press the
SOURCE
sent, and then the amplifi er source changes to DVD.
2. Press the buttons to operate the DVD.
The indicator is shown on the LCD while the
remote control codes are being transmitted. It is not
displayed when buttons without stored code are
pressed.
3. The direct buttons can be used to perform up
to 20 operations for each of the 12 sources,
including DVD, TV, AMP, and other AV
equipment.
The buttons consist of the D1 to D5 buttons, and
the equipment is operated by pressing the buttons
corresponding to the indicators on the LCD.
Four pages are available, and press the > button
to select a page. The current page position is
displayed on the LCD.
PRESET MODE
(When operating non-Marantz AV equipment
products)
This remote controller is preset with remote control
codes from AV equipment by other manufacturers.
The preset codes are TV, VCR, LD, CABLE, DSS,
DVD, TAPE, TUNER, CD/CD-R, MD and AMP.
Settings can be made in one of two ways.
When the preset codes are set, the following codes
are contained in the
controller.
SOURCE
button once changes the
button twice (double-click). The code is
SOURCE button of the remote
See the attached manufacturer number list for the
preset manufacturers, devices, preset numbers, and
other settings.
Remote control
source name
TVTVTelevision
DVDDVDDVD player
VCRVCRVideo deck
DSSSATELLITESatellite broadcasting
TUNER
CDCD/CD-R PLAYERCD pla yer
CD-RCD/CD-R PLAYERCD recorder
MDCD/CD-R PLAYER MD deck
TAPETAPECassette deck
AUX1CABLECable television
AUX2LASER DISCLaser disc player
AMPAMPLIFIERAmplifi er or receiver
Corresponding
preset code
RECEIVER/TUNER
RECEIVER/TUNER
Device name
tuner equipment
AM FM TUNER
• When using Marantz products, TV and DVD can
be set to TV1 (TV/VDP: Projector) and TV2 (PDP:
Plasma display), and DVD1 (fi rst DVD player) and
DVD2 (second DVD player), respectively, to match
the customer’s operating environment. These
settings are made in PRESET mode.
In the factory default state, the remote controller is
set to TV1 and DVD1. To make the presets, enter
the numbers below while referring to the section
“Entering and Setting the Manufacturer Number
Directly”.
TV1: 0001, TV2: 0002
DVD1: 0001, DVD2: 0002
Entering and Setting the Manufacturer Number Directly
Refer to the manufacturer number list.
This example shows how to set a SAMSUNG DVD
player.
2 3 4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
1 23
5 6
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
4
4
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
1. View the supplied manufacturer number list,
and fi nd the number of the manufacturer for the
device that you are using.
Hold down the M button for three seconds or
2.
more.
The menu is displayed.
3. Press the D1 (PRESET) direct button.
The Preset setting (P-SET) is displayed.
Press the DVD source button.
4.
Press the numeric buttons to enter the four-
5.
digit manufacturer number.
Example: To enter “0600” from the manufacturer
number list.
To correct the entered number, use the 1 or 2
cursor button to enter the correct number.
• If no button is pressed for over one minute
during the setting process, any settings that
were made are cancelled.
6. Press the OK cursor button.
Confirm the OK is displayed and then the
7.
display returns to the Preset Setting (P-SET).
When the manufacturer number is entered correctly,
OK is displayed momentarily on the screen.
• If you enter a number not in the manufacturer
number list, WRONG CODE is displayed,
and then you return to the preset setting
again
Check the manufacturer number list, and
either set a different number or use the
sequence function to set.
To set the manufacturer number for another
8.
source device, repeat the procedure in steps 4
to 6.
After the settings are completed, press the M
9.
button.
Press the buttons on the remote controller to
10.
check that the DVD can be operated correctly.
Setting Equipment Not Appearing in Manufacturer
Number List
Use the sequence function to set equipment not
appearing in the manufacturer number list. You may
still be unable to set some equipment even when
using the sequence function. In this case, the remote
controller can be programmed with codes individually.
In the sequence function, the power ON/OFF codes
are transmitted by pressing the remote controller
buttons in order.
If the power for the equipment is left on, hold down
the button until the equipment is turned off, and then
release. This completes the setting.
This example shows how to set a DVD player.
4 5 7
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
4
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
1. Turn on the power of the DVD player.
Hold down the M button for three seconds or
2.
more.
The menu is displayed.
3. Press the D1 (PRESET) direct button.
The Preset setting (P-SET) is displayed.
4. Press the DVD source button.
Hold down the CH+ or CH– button for one
5.
second or more.
Press the CH+ button repeatedly in the interval
6.
for one second.
The signal is transmitted, and the display cycles
through the code number.
Press the
CH–
button to go back to a number
screen.
7. Release the button once the DVD player turns
off.
Press the OK cursor button.
8.
Confirm the OK is displayed and then the
9.
display returns to the Preset Setting (P-SET).
To set the manufacturer number for another
10.
source device, repeat the procedure in steps 4
to 8.
After the settings are completed, press the M
11.
button.
Press the buttons on the remote controller to
12.
check that the DVD can be operated correctly.
Check the following points if the equipment which
was set does not operate properly.
• If there is more than one number in the manufacturer
number list, try setting a different number.
• There may be some buttons which cannot be
used. Program the codes to the required buttons.
ENGLISH
17
ENGLISH
LEARN MODE
Programming the 2 (PLAY) and Other Control Buttons and Numeric Buttons
This remote controller is capable of learning and
storing codes used by other remote controllers that
you already own.
For codes which are not learned, the remote
controller will transmit either the Marantz preset
codes from the initial settings, or remote codes from
another manufacturer’s AV equipment which is set
by the customer.
The receiver sensor for the remote control signals is
located at the top of the remote controller.
This example shows how to learn the codes from the
remote control of a DVD player.
1 2 4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
1 23
6 (When OK) (failed) (codes are full)
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
1. Hold down the M button for three seconds or
more.
The menu is displayed.
2. Press the D2 (LEARN) direct button.
The LEARN setting (LEARN) is displayed. The
indicator then blinks.
3. Press the DVD source button.
Press the 2 (PLAY) button.
4.
The
indicate that learning is ready.
5. Place the receiver sensor of the remote control
(top) so that it is facing the transmitter of the
DVD remote control (top) at a distance of about
5 cm (2 inches).
LEARN
NAME
USE
PAGE
4
4
LEARN
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
indicator blinks, and then displays to
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
Press and hold down the 2 (PLAY) button of the
6.
transmitting DVD remote control, and check that
OK is displayed on the LCD.
The remote controller has finished learning when
OK is displayed on the LCD.
If ERROR is displayed on the LCD, some error has
prevented the command from being learned. If this
happens, repeat the procedure for steps 4 and 5.
In some rare cases, ERROR may be displayed
repeatedly during the learning operation. In this
case, the transmitting remote control may have
special signal codes. These codes cannot be
learned by this remote controller.
7. Follow the same procedure to make the remote
control learn the other buttons.
Repeat the procedure in steps 3 to 6 to have
8.
the remote control learn the signal codes from
a TV, CD player, or other AV equipment.
• When no buttons are pressed for
approximately one minute during the
learning operation, the remote controller
automatically returns to USE mode.
4
• When programming the source buttons,
switch to the source in step 3, and then
press the source button again.
9. When you have finished programming the
codes for each button, press the M button.
The
USE
indicator is displayed on the LCD, and the
newly stored codes can be used.
• If FULL is displayed on the LCD, the memory
4
cannot hold any more learned codes in
LEARN mode.
If FULL is displayed no matter how many
times you try the learning operation, the
remote controller cannot accept any more
new codes until some of the previously
LEARN
learned codes are deleted from the memory.
Delete some of the learned buttons from the
sources.
The M button and > button cannot be taught. Only
each one code can be learned for the LIGHT buttons
1 and 2, regardless of the source.
Programming the Direct Buttons and Rewriting
Names
This example shows how to program codes from
other manufacturer products to the DVD MENU
button (D1) and change the display to OSD.
6 7 8
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
1. Hold down the M button for three seconds or
more.
The menu is displayed.
2. Press the D2 (LEARN) direct button.
The LEARN setting (LEARN) indicator is displayed.
The
3. Press the DVD source button.
The first page of the direct button screen is
displayed. There are four available pages. Pressing
the > buttons cycles through the pages in this order
1 → 2 → 3 → 4 → 1.
4. Press the D1 (MENU) direct button.
The
indicate that learning is ready.
5. Place the receiver sensor of the remote control
(top) so that it is facing the transmitter of the
DVD remote control (top) at a distance of about
5 cm (2 inches).
Press and hold down the OSD button of the
6.
transmitting DVD remote control, and check that
OK is displayed on the LCD.
The remote controller has finished learning when
OK is displayed on the LCD.
If ERROR is displayed on the LCD, some error has
prevented the command from being learned. If this
happens, repeat the procedure for steps 4 and 5.
• After learning is completed, the remote
controller automatically switches to name
rewriting mode. The left end “ ” indicator on
the MENU blinks to indicate that the blinking
part can be rewritten.
• If no names will be rewritten, press the
OK cursor button. The display returns to
learning standby mode by pressing the OK
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
LEARN
indicator then blinks.
LEARN
indicator blinks, and then displays to
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
4
123
4
7. To change the name, press the numeric
buttons to enter the text.
• Use the cursor buttons 1 2 to move to the
sections to be rewritten on the LCD.
• To change MENU to OSD, press the 5
numeric button.
Each time the button is pressed, the display
cycles through M → N → O → 5 → M.
After rewriting of the text is completed, press
8.
the OK cursor button.
To delete text that is already entered, press the 0
button to insert a space.
• In this example, MENU is changed to “OSD
(space) (space)” in this step, and then OSD
is displayed in the right side by pressing the
OK button.
For details, refer to the section “Rewriting Names”.
9. In the same way, use the > button to select
the page, and then press the direct button to
program the codes.
After programming the codes for each of the
10.
buttons, press the M button.
The
USE
indicator displays on the LCD, and the
newly stored codes can be transmitted.
REWRITING NAMES
This remote controller allows the rewriting of names
for the sources and direct buttons. This operation is
performed for each individual source.
This example shows how to change the source name
from DVD to AVD and AUDIO to SOUND.
3 4 5
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
4
123
4
7 8 9
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
4
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
cursor button.
1. Hold down the M button for three seconds or
more.
The menu is displayed.
2. Press the D3 (NAME) direct button .
18
3. Press the DVD source button .
The
The “
NAME
indicator blinks.
” blinks to indicate that the letter can be
changed.
4. Press the 2 cursor button twice.
The D in DVD blinks to indicate that the letter can
be changed.
5. Press the 1 numeric button to select A.
Each time the numeric buttons are pressed, the
button cycles through the alphanumeric characters
shown below.
1: A → B → C → 1 → A
2: D → E → F → 2 → D
3: G → H → I → 3 → G
4: J → K → L → 4 → J
5: M → N → O → 5 → M
6: P → Q → R → 6 → P
7: S → T → U → 7 → S
8: V → W → X → 8 → V
9: Y
→
Z → / → 9 →
0: SPACE (
SPACE (
→
6. Press the 1 or 2 cursor button .
The letter is changed to “A”.
Y
) → + → — → , → ’ → < → > → ? → 0
)
• The 3 and 4 cursor buttons can be used to
move the blinking indicator of the section to
be rewritten.
7. Press the 3 or 4 cursor buttons to select
AUDIO on the direct button indicator. The
A fl ashes to indicate that the name can be
changed.
Press the 7 numeric button to select S.
8.
Each time the button is pressed, the button cycles
through S → T → U → 7 → S.
9. Press the 2 cursor button to move the fl ashing
section.
Press the 5 numeric button to select 0.
10.
Follow the same procedure to enter U, N, and
11.
D.
When fi nished entering the text, press the OK
12.
cursor button .
Press the M button .
13.
The
The input is overwritten, and so the currently
Up to six characters can be entered for the direct
USE
indicator displays on the LCD, and the
newly stored codes can be used.
displayed text is erased.
button indicator.
ERASING PROGRAMMED CODES
(RETURNING TO INITIAL SETTINGS)
Codes can be erased in fi ve ways: by buttons, direct
buttons, direct button pages, sources, and by all
memory contents.
Erasing Buttons and Erasing Direct Buttons
This example shows how to erase the code learned
from the PLAY button of the DVD player and the
AUTO code of the AMP direct button.
Erasing buttons
1 3 4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
1 23
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
1. Hold down the M button for three seconds or
more.
The menu is displayed.
2. Press the D5 (ERASE) direct button .
Press the DVD source button .
3.
The
USE
and
LEARN
indicators blink.
4. Press the button 2 (PLAY) that you want to
erase while holding down the CLEAR button .
A message is displayed on the LCD.
5. Press the D4 (YES) direct button to erase.
The code programmed to the 2 (PLAY) button is
erased.
When the code is cleared, the code for this button
resets to the factory default code or becomes blank.
• To cancel the erasing operation, press the
D5 (NO) button to return to the previous
display.
To erase codes programmed for the CLEAR
button, simply press the CLEAR button
twice.
To erase codes programmed for the
SOURCE button, simply press the SOURCE
button twice.
Erasing direct buttons
6 8 9
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
6. Press the AMP source button .
Press the > button to display the fi rst page for
7.
AMP.
Press the D1 (AUTO) direct button to be erased
8.
while holding down the CLEAR button .
Press the D4 (YES) direct button to erase.
9.
The code programmed to the
AUTO
button is
erased.
When the code is cleared, the code for this button
resets to the factory default code or becomes blank.
The rewritten name returns to the original name.
• To cancel the erasing operation, press the
D5 (NO) button to return to the previous
screen.
When the erasing operation is fi nished, press
10.
the M button .
The
USE
remote controller can now be operated.
indicator displays to indicate that the
Erasing Direct Button Pages
This example shows how to erase the entire direct
button second page learned from the DVD player.
1 3 4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
1 23
4
5
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
Hold down the M button for three seconds or
1.
more.
The menu is displayed.
2. Press the D5 (ERASE) direct button .
Press the DVD source button .
3.
The
USE
and
4. Press the > button to display the second page.
Press the > button while holding down the
5.
CLEAR button .
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
LEARN
indicators blink.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
PAGE
123
4
Press the D4 (YES) direct button to erase.
6.
All codes and names programmed to page 2 are
erased. When the codes are cleared, the codes
for this button reset to the factory default code or
become blank. Any rewritten names return to the
original name.
• To cancel the erasing operation, press the
D5 (NO) button to return to the previous
screen.
When the erasing operation is fi nished, press
7.
the M button .
The
USE
indicator lights up to indicate that the
remote controller can now be operated.
Erasing Sources
This procedure clears all codes and names
programmed to the DVD, TV, or other sources. All
codes and names in the four direct button pages are
also erased.
This example shows how to erase the names and
codes learned from the DVD player.
1 3 4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
1 23
4
1. Hold down the M button for three seconds or
more.
The menu is displayed.
2. Press the D5 (ERASE) direct button .
Press the DVD source button .
3.
The
USE
and
4. Press the DVD source button while holding
down the CLEAR button .
Press the D4 (YES) direct button to erase.
5.
All codes and names programmed to the DVD
source are erased. When the codes are cleared,
the codes for this button reset to the factory default
code or become blank. Any rewritten names return
to the original name.
• To cancel the erasing operation, press the
D5 (NO) button to return to the previous
display.
6. When the erasing operation is fi nished, press
the M button .
The
USE
indicator displays to indicate that the
remote controller can now be operated.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
LEARN
indicators blink.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
123
4
ENGLISH
19
ENGLISH
Erasing All
This procedure clears (resets) all programmed
codes and names. Once all the data is cleared, the
memory is returned to the factory default status. The
programmed macros are also erased.
1 3 4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
1 23
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
1. Hold down the M button for three seconds or
more.
The menu is displayed.
2. Press the D5 (ERASE) direct button .
The
USE
and
LEARN
indicators blink.
3. Press the CLEAR button while holding down
the POWER ON and OFF buttons at the same
time.
Press the D4 (YES) direct button to erase.
4.
All programmed codes and names are erased and
reset to the factory default settings.
• To cancel the erasing operation, press the
D5 (NO) button to return to the previous
screen.
• To erase all operation takes a few seconds
after the D4 (YES) button is pressed.
PROGRAMMING MACROS
This remote controller can program a series of button
operations in sequence.
Macros are a function that makes it possible to
use a single button operation to perform a complex
series of button operations any number of times. A
single button can be programmed to perform up to
20 steps in sequence. A total of 20 buttons can be
programmed with macros.
• For example, the following sequence of operations
can be programmed to a macro.
Switch amplifi er to DVD source → Set amplifi er
mode to AUTO → Play DVD player → Switch TV
to video input
The factory default for the transmission interval
(time) between macro operations is one second,
but these signal transmission intervals can be set
between approximately 0.5 seconds and 5 seconds
in the Setup mode. Each transmission interval can
be adjusted independently when programming or
revising a macro.
20
Note:
• If the signal transmission interval (interval time)
is changed using the Setup mode (described later),
this transmission interval is applied to all macro
programs. To change individual signal transmission
intervals, use the procedures in this section for
programming macros and revising macros.
4. Press the buttons in the sequence that you
want the operations performed.
The actual program starts here.
Each time a button is pressed, the name of the
button is displayed on the LCD.
4-1 4-2 4-3
• No signals are transmitted while programming a
macro.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
• The M button, > button, cursor buttons, MEMO
button, CLEAR button, and VOL buttons cannot
be programmed.
• If no button is pressed for approximately one
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
4
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
minute during programming, the remote controller
returns to the state before macro mode.
In this case, the macro program is not stored.
• When executing macro mode, performing the
source switching operation two or more times
only changes the remote control mode and does
not transmit any signals. (Switching of the source
selector of the amplifi er is valid only once.)
Press the DVD source button .
4-1.
Press the 2 (PLAY) button .
4-2.
Press the 3 or 4 cursor buttons .
4-3.
The interval time is displayed on the LCD.
Press the 3 or 4 cursor buttons and set to 2.0
4-4.
(seconds).
• Use the 3 cursor button to increase the time
PROGRAMMING MACROS
This example shows how to program a macro to the
M-01 button.
(The screens shown in the example are the default
factory states. If the names of direct buttons
were rewritten, these modified names would be
displayed.)
Switch amplifi er to DVD source → Play DVD player
→ Set the interval to 2 seconds until the next signal is
sent → Switch TV to video input → Set the amplifi er
mode to AUTO
1 2 3
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
1 23
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
4
PAGE
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
and the 4 button to decrease the time. The
interval time can be set from 0.5 seconds to
5 seconds.
• To stop the time adjustment, press the D5
(CANCEL) direct button.
Press the OK cursor button .
4-5.
Press the TV source button .
4-6.
Press the > button to display the fi rst page.
4-7.
Press the D1 (INPUT) direct button .
4-8.
Press the AMP source button .
4-9.
Press the > button to display the fi rst page.
4-10.
Press the D1 (AUTO) direct button .
4-11.
Press the OK cursor button .
4-12.
The LCD displays END to indicate that programming
is completed.
5. To program another macro, repeat the
procedure in steps 3 to 4-12.
1. Hold down the M button for three seconds or
more.
The menu is displayed.
2. Press the D4 (MACRO) direct button .
The macro menu is displayed.
The
3. Press the D1 (M-01) direct button .
The menu has four pages, and so use the > button
MACRO
indicator displays and
LEARN
blinks.
to select the page when programming other buttons.
To exit macro programming, press the M button
6.
.
The
USE
remote controller can now be operated.
indicator displays to indicate that the
When the macro are programmed 20 operations or
more, the display returns macro menu.
Edit the macro so that it has 20 operations or less.
EXECUTING MACRO PROGRAMS
1 2 3
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
Press the M button shortly.
1.
The macro menu is displayed.
Press the D1 (M-01) direct button .
2.
Check that the operations of the program are
3.
executed step by step.
The name of the operation button is displayed on
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
4
PAGE
123
the LCD.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
4
• The programmed section is indicated by
&. The bar indicator moves to indicate the
progress of the program.
Select DVD source → PLAY transmit → Interval
time: 2 seconds → Select TV → TV INPUT transmit
Select AMP → AUTO transmit → End
→
• To cancel transmission of the program while
it is in progress, press any button.
CHANGING NAMES OF MACRO PROGRAMS
Under the factory default settings, the names of the
macro programs are set from M-01 to M-20, but you
can change them to any desired name.
The text can have up to six characters, and it is
entered using the numeric buttons.
This example shows how to change the M-01 name
to MOVIE.
1 2 3
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
1 23
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
4
PAGE
123
4
4 5 6
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
1. Hold down the M button for three seconds or
more.
The menu is displayed.
2. Press the D4 (MACRO) direct button.
The macro menu is displayed.
The
3. Press the D1 (M-01) direct button .
The NAME is displayed.
4. Press the D3 (NAME) direct button .
The “ ” blinks to indicate that rewriting is possible.
MACRO
indicator displays and
LEARN
blinks.
5. Press the 5 numeric button to select M.
Press the 2 cursor button to next.
6.
The “ ” blinks to indicate that rewriting is possible.
Press the 5 numeric button to select O.
7.
Repeat steps 6 and 7, and then enter V, I, E and
8.
“ (space)”.
• To make changes in the text while entering
it, use the 1 or 2 cursor buttons to move to
the blinking section.
After making the changes, press the OK cursor
9.
button.
• To change the names of other macro
programs, repeat the procedure in steps 3
to 9.
To exit, press the M button.
10.
ERASING STEPS OF MACRO PROGRAMS
This example shows how to delete the TV and
INPUT steps from the following macro programmed
to M-01.
The program is changed from
DVD → PLAY → TIME → TV → INPUT → AMP →
AUTO
to
DVD → PLAY → TIME → AMP → AUTO.
1 2 3
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
1 23
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
4
PAGE
123
4
4 5 6
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
Hold down the M button for three seconds or
1.
more.
The menu is displayed.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
Press the D4 (MACRO) direct button.
2.
The macro menu is displayed.
The
MACRO
indicator displays and
LEARN
blinks.
3. Press the D1 (M-01) direct button.
Press the D5 (EDIT) direct button.
4.
The LCD displays DVD, and the step position is
indicated by 9.
The programmed section is indicated by &.
5. Press the 2 cursor button to display TV.
Press the CLEAR button .
6.
The LCD displays CLEAR, and TV and INPUT are
deleted.
When deleting steps from a macro program, the
operations performed for a source after switching to
the source are also deleted.
If the
CLEAR
button is pressed at the INPUT
position, only the INPUT step is deleted.
The & indicator for the step is also changed.
• To check the modifi ed steps, press the 1 or
2 cursor button.
To exit, press the M button.
7.
When fi nished, to change another macro program,
press the OK cursor button to return to the menu,
and then repeat the procedure for steps 3 to 6.
OVERWRITING STEPS IN MACRO PROGRAMS
This example shows how to change the macro
programmed to M-01 from
DVD → PLAY → AMP → AUTO
to
DVD → PLAY → TV → INPUT.
4 6 7
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
Hold down the M button for three seconds or
1.
more.
The menu is displayed.
Press the D4 (MACRO) direct button.
2.
The macro menu is displayed.
The
3.
4.
The LCD displays DVD, and the step position is
MACRO
Press the D1 (M-01) direct button.
Press the D5 (EDIT) direct button.
indicated by 9.
The programmed section is indicated by &.
Press the 2 cursor button so that AMP is
5.
displayed.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
4
123
indicator displays and
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
LEARN
4
blinks.
4
Press the TV source button.
6.
TV blinks for 0.5 seconds.
Press the D1 (INPUT) direct button.
7.
INPUT blinks for 0.5 seconds.
TV and INPUT are overwritten.
• To check the modifi ed steps, press the 1 or
2 cursor button.
To exit, press the M button.
8.
When fi nished, to change another macro program,
press the OK cursor button to return to the menu,
and then repeat the procedure for steps 3 to 8.
INSERTING STEPS IN MACRO PROGRAMS
This example shows how to change the macro
programmed to M-01 from
DVD → PLAY → AMP → AUTO
to
DVD → PLAY → TV → INPUT → AMP → AUTO
4 6 8
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
Hold down the M button for three seconds or
1.
more.
The menu is displayed.
Press the D4 (MACRO) direct button.
2.
The macro menu is displayed.
The
3.
4.
The LCD displays DVD, and the step position is
MACRO
Press the D1 (M-01) direct button .
Press the D5 (EDIT) direct button .
indicated by 7.
The programmed section is indicated by &.
Press the 2 cursor button so that AMP is
5.
displayed.
Press the MEMO button.
6.
Press the TV source button.
7.
TV blinks for 0.5 seconds
Press the D1 (INPUT) direct button.
8.
INPUT blinks for 0.5 seconds.
TV and INPUT are inserted.
Press the OK cursor button.
9.
• To check the modifi ed steps, press the 1 or
2 cursor button.
To exit, press the M button.
10.
When fi nished, to change another macro program,
press the OK cursor button to return to the menu,
and then repeat the procedure for steps 3 to 9.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
4
123
indicator displays and
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
LEARN
PAGE
123
blinks.
4
4
CLEARING MACRO PROGRAMS
When clearing macros, the macros programmed to
the button are erased. Modifi ed macro names are
also returned to the factory default settings. This
example shows how to clear a macro with the name
MOVIE programmed to M-02.
1 4 5
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
Press the M button for three second or more.
1.
The macro menu is displayed.
Press the D4 (MACRO) direct button .
2.
The macro menu is displayed.
Press the D2 (MOVIE) direct button while
3.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
holding down the CLEAR button.
Press the D4 (YES) direct button to clear the
4.
macro.
To cancel the clearing operation, press the NO (D5
button).
To exit, press the M button.
5.
When fi nished, to change another macro program,
press the OK cursor button to return to the menu,
and then repeat the procedure for steps 2 to 4.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
4
123
4
ENGLISH
21
ENGLISH
SETTING THE MACRO TIMER
Setting the macro timer enables the macro program
to automatically turn the power for a device on or off
or perform other operations.
In the settings, you can select to execute the macro
timer everyday or only once.
Be sure to set the clock to the correct time before
using the timer. The macro timer can only be set for
one program a day.
This example shows how to use the timer only once
at 20:35 to execute a macro programmed to M-01.
2 3 4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
4
PAGE
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
5 6
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
Hold down the M button for three seconds or
1.
more.
The menu is displayed.
Press the > button to display the third page
2.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
4
TIMER menu.
Press the D2 (ONCE?) direct button.
3.
The M-TMR menu is displayed on the LCD.
• To cancel timer operation, press CANCEL.
Press the D1 (M-01) direct button .
4.
The time which is set previously is displayed.
Press the 2 and 0 numeric button to set the
5.
hour indicator to 20.
Press the 3 and 5 numeric button to set the
6.
minute indicator to 35.
Press the OK cursor button.
7.
This fi nalizes the time.
To exit, press the M button.
8.
To cancel the macro timer, return to the TIMER
menu and press the D5 (CANCEL) and then press
D1 (M-01).
22
EXECUTING THE MACRO TIMER
The macro program starts when the time that was
set is reached. The TIMER indicator lights up
whenever the macro timer is activated.
Note:
• To execute the macro timer, place the remote
controller facing the infrared sensor of the device
to be operated. If the remote controller is not in
a suitable position, it may not operate the device
properly.
CLONE MODE
CREATING COPIES USING CLONE MODE
All of the codes programmed to the RC8001SR remote
4
controller can be copied to another RC8001SR using
a few simple operations.
• The remote controller can copy the entire contents
or the contents for specifi c source buttons.
• When copying the entire contents, all programmed
codes, modifi ed names, programmed macros, and
signal transmission intervals are copied.
When copying the contents for source buttons, the
programmed codes and modifi ed names are copied.
Note:
• The clone function can only be used for copying
when using the same model (RC8001SR) for both
the transmitting and receiving remote controller.
Place the receiver sensor of the receiving
1.
remote control (top) so that it is facing the
transmitter of the transmitting remote control
(top) at a distance of about 5 cm (2 inches).
Hold down the M button of the transmitting
2.
remote controller for three seconds or more.
The menu is displayed.
Press the > button to display the fourth page
3.
CLONE menu.
Press the D3 (TX) direct button.
4.
The transmitting side is now ready.
Hold down the M button of the receiving remote
5.
controller for three seconds or more.
The menu is displayed.
Press the > button to display the fourth page
6.
CLONE menu.
Press the D1 (RX) direct button.
7.
The receiving side is now ready.
Press the OK cursor button on the receiving
8.
remote controller.
Press the OK cursor button on the transmitting
9.
remote controller.
When copying is started, the bar indicators on both
LCDs start to move from the left to the right.
• When the copying operation is completed,
TX OK is displayed on the LCD of the
transmitting remote controller, and RX OK
is displayed on the LCD of the receiving
remote controller.
COPYING ENTIRE CONTENTS
<Transmitting remote controller>
3 4 9
• Do not touch either of the remote controllers
during the copying operation. Doing so
could cause copying to fail.
• If the copying fails in the middle of the
copying process, RX ERROR is displayed
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
4
PAGE
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
on the receiving remote controller. Check
and perform steps 1 to 7 again.
• Copying takes about three minutes to
complete when the transmitting remote
controller has been programmed to 100%
<Receiving remote controller>
5 6 9
capacity.
Once copying is completed, press the M button
10.
on both remote controllers.
COPYING BY SOURCE
The 12 sources can be copied on a source by source
basis. You can select from up to 12 source types.
<Receiving remote controller>
6 7 8
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
Place the receiver sensor of the receiving
1.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
4
PAGE
123
4
remote control (top) so that it is facing the
transmitter of the transmitting remote control
(top) at a distance of about 5 cm (2 inches).
Hold down the M button of the transmitting
2.
remote controller for three seconds or more.
The menu is displayed.
Press the > button to display the fourth page
3.
CLONE menu.
Press the D3 (TX) direct button.
4.
The transmitting side is now ready.
Hold down the M button of the receiving remote
5.
controller for three seconds or more.
Press the > button to display the fourth page
6.
CLONE menu.
Press the D2 (RX-S) direct button.
7.
Press the source button to be copied.
8.
The receiving side is now ready.
The name of the source which was pressed is
displayed on the LCD.
• Each time the source button is pressed, the
name is displayed on the LCD.
Press the OK cursor button on the receiving
9.
remote controller.
Press the OK cursor button on the transmitting
10.
remote controller.
When copying is started, the bar indicators on both
LCDs start to move from the left to the right.
• When the copying operation is completed,
TX OK is displayed on the LCD of the
transmitting remote controller, and RX OK
is displayed on the LCD of the receiving
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
remote controller.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
4
PAGE
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
• Do not touch either of the remote controllers
during the copying operation. Doing so
could cause copying to fail.
• If the copying fails in the middle of the
copying process, ERROR is displayed on
the remote controller.
Check and perform steps 1 to 7 again.
Once copying is completed, press the M button
11.
on both remote controllers.
SETUP
SETTING THE LIGHTING TIME
• The LCD lights up when the LIGHT buttons are
pressed. The LCD remains lit while the pressed
button is held down, and it goes off when the
button is released.
• The LCD continues to light up if another button
is pressed while it is lit or if pressed within two
seconds after the light goes off.
• The lighting time can be set in one-second units
from 0 to 60 seconds.
The LIGHT buttons have light-absorbing properties
that enable them to store light. If the buttons are no
longer illuminated in a dimly lit environment, bring the
buttons near a fl uorescent lamp or other light source
for a suffi cient amount of time. This should illuminate
the buttons again.
• The LIGHT buttons consist of a LIGHT1 and
LIGHT2 button, and they both perform the same
operation.
The factory default lighting time is set to 15 seconds.
This example shows how to set the lighting time to
20 seconds.
2 3 4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
Hold down the M button for three seconds or
1.
more.
The menu is displayed.
Press the > button to display the second page
2.
SETUP menu.
Press the D1 (LIGHT) direct button .
3.
The LIGHT is displayed on the LCD
Press the 3 or 4 cursor button to set the
4.
lighting time.
Press the OK cursor button to enter the lighting
5.
time.
Once the setting is finished, press the M
6.
button.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
4
PAGE
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
SETTING THE MACRO INTERVAL TIME
When a macro program is executed, control signals
are transmitted in sequence. This transmission
interval (interval time) can be set in 0.5-seconds units
from 0.5 to 5 seconds.
If the interval time is set in this Setup mode, the
interval times for all programmed macros are
changed. If necessary, use EDIT (see page 60) in the
macro program to change the individual transmission
times.
The factory default setting for the transmission
interval is 1 second.
This example shows how to set the interval time to
5 seconds.
2 3 4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
Hold down the M button for three seconds or
1.
more.
The menu is displayed.
Press the > button to display the second page
2.
SETUP menu.
Press the D2 (I-TIME) direct button.
3.
Press the 3 or 4 cursor button to set the
4.
interval time.
Holding down the cursor button fast-forwards the
time indicator.
Press the OK cursor button to enter the interval
5.
time.
Once the setting is finished, press the M
6.
button.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
4
PAGE
123
4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
ADJUSTING THE DISPLAY CONTRAST
The contrast of the LCD can be adjusted. Adjust
for maximum visibility according to your viewing
environment.
2 3 4
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
123
4
Hold down the M button for three seconds or
1.
more.
The menu is displayed.
Press the > button to display the second page
2.
MACRO
LEARN
NAME
USE
PAGE
123
4
SETUP menu.
Press the D3 (CONT) direct button .
3.
Press the 3 or 4 cursor button and set the
4.
display contrast for maximum visibility.
The adjustment has 10 levels.
The factory default setting for the contrast is the fi fth
level.
Press the OK cursor button to enter the display
5.
contrast.
Once the setting is finished, press the M
6.
button.
MACRO
LEARN
NAME
USE
PAGE
123
4
ENGLISH
23
ENGLISH
REMOTE CONTROL
OPERATION (RC101)
NAME AND FUNCTION
The included remote controller can be used in multiroom systems. Using this remote controller, you can
operate the unit through infrared receivers or the
infrared receptor of Marantz products in multiple
rooms. The SOURCE ON/OFF button and control
buttons are used in common across different input
source components.
The input source controlled with the remote controller
changes when one of the input selector buttons is
pressed.
⁄7
⁄6
⁄5
⁄4
⁄3
⁄2
z
x
c
v
b
n
m
,
.
⁄0
⁄1
z POWER ON and OFF buttons
(When Zone (MULTI ROOM) A/B mode is
selected)
These buttons are used to turn on or off, for the multi
room control or multi speaker control of the unit.
(When Zone D (MAIN ROOM) mode is selected)
These buttons are used to turn on or off, for the unit
in main room.
x SOURCE ON and OFF buttons
These buttons are used to turn on or off a specifi c
source (such as a DVD player) independently from
the rest of the system.
c AMP - SOURCE /Numeric buttons
SOURCE buttons
These buttons are used to switch the source of
the unit. Each time a source button is pressed, the
remote control changes to the source which was
pressed.
This remote controller can control 12 types of
equipment. To change the unit source, press this
button twice within two seconds. The signal is sent
when it is pressed the second time.
Note:
The T2 button is not used for this unit.
(When Zone (MULTI ROOM) A/B mode is
selected)
These buttons are used to select the source for the
multi room/multi speaker control of the unit.
(When Zone D (MAIN ROOM) mode is selected)
These buttons are used to select the source for the
unit in main room.
Numeric buttons
Use these buttons only for preset setting.
v AMP - VOL +/- buttons
(When Zone (MULTI ROOM) A/B mode is
selected)
These buttons are used to adjust the volume for the
multi room control or multi speaker.
(When Zone D (MAIN ROOM) mode is selected)
These buttons are used to adjust the volume for the
unit in main room.
b AMP - MUTE button
(When Zone (MULTI ROOM) A/B mode is
selected)
This button is used to mute the audio for the multi
room control or multi speaker control of the unit.
(When Zone D (MAIN ROOM) mode is selected)
These buttons are used to mute the audio for the unit
in main room.
n 3, 4, 1, 2 (CURSOR) / ENTER
buttons
These buttons are used when operating cursor of a
source.
(When Tuner mode (T1) is selected)
PRESET +/ PRESET - buttons
Used to select a preset station up and down.
TUNE 3 /TUNE 4 buttons
Used to tune a frequency station up and down.
m SLEEP button
(When Zone (MULTI ROOM) A/B mode is
selected)
This button is used for setting the sleep timer of multi
room control mode.
(When Zone D (MAIN ROOM) mode is selected)
This button is used for setting the sleep timer of the
unit receiver in main room.
, CONTROL buttons
These buttons are used when operating PLAY, STOP,
PAUSE and other commands of a source.
(When TUNER mode (T1) is selected)
P.SCAN button
Used to start preset scan.
CLEAR button
Used to stop preset scan.
. A/B/C/D buttons
(When TUNER mode (T1) is selected)
Used to select the band of tuner (AM/FM/XM/DAB).
(When the other source is selected)
Reserve key for the learning commands.
⁄0 SET button
This button is used to enter learn mode, preset mode
and clone mode.
⁄1 ZONE (MULTI ROOM) button
This button is used to set the zone area.
• Zone A: MULTI ROOM A
• Zone B: MULTI ROOM B
(The SR7002 does not use this zone.)
• Zone C: The unit does not use this zone.
• Zone D: MAIN ROOM
⁄2 DISC+/T.MODE
(When TUNER mode (T1) is selected)
Used to select auto stereo mode or mono mode
when the FM band is selected.
The “AUTO” indicator lights in the auto stereo mode.
(When CD/DVD/CDR mode is selected)
Used to change the disc for the CD/DVD/CDR
changer.
⁄3 INFO button
(When Zone (MULTI ROOM) A mode is selected)
When this button is pressed, the current setting for
selected multi room control of the unit is displayed on
the TV monitor.
(When Zone D (MAIN ROOM) mode is selected)
When this button is pressed, the current setting for
the unit are displayed on the TV monitor.
⁄4 MENU/INPUT button
(When DVD mode is selected)
Used to menu command.
(When TV mode is selected)
Used to select the TV video input.
⁄5 CH 3/4 buttons
These buttons are used to change channels in TV
mode and DSS mode.
⁄6 SEND indicator
Indicates when the remote controller is transmitting
a signal.
⁄7 LEARN indicator
Indicates when the remote controller is in the LEARN
mode.
24
GENERAL INFORMATION OF RC101 TO THE UNIT
The included remote controller can be used in multi-room systems. Using this remote controller, you can
operate the unit through infrared receivers or the infrared receptor of Marantz products in multiple rooms.
Zone A: Multi room A control
Zone B: Multi room B control
(The SR7002 does not use this zone)
Zone C: The unit does not use this zone.
POWER ON/OFF
SOURCE
VOL +/–
MUTEDecreases the sound temporarily.
SLEEPSets the sleep timer function.
INFO
Zone D: Main room control
POWER ON/OFF Turns on or off for main room of the unit.
SOURCE
VOL +/–
MUTEDecreases the sound temporarily.
SLEEPSets the sleep timer function.
INFO
Turns on or off for each multi zone of
the unit.
Selects a particular source component for
each multi zone.
Adjusts the over all sound level for each
multi zone.
Turns on or off the “On Screen Display” for
the multi zone.
Selects a particular source component
for main zone.
Adjusts the over all sound level for Main
room.
Turns on or off the “On Screen Display” for
the main room.
CONTROLLING MARANTZ COMPONENTS
1. Press the desired SOURCE button.
2. Press the desired operation buttons to play the selected component.
• For details, refer to the component’s user guide.
• It may not be possible to operate some models.
CONTROLLING A MARANTZ TV (TV)
SOURCE ON/OFF Turns the TV on and off
MENU/INPUTSelect the TV video input
CH3/4Selects TV channel up or down
ENTER
3(CURSOR)
4(CURSOR)
2(CURSOR)
1(CURSOR)
2
9
;
§
∞
6
5
DISC+/T.MODE–
AReserve for learinig
BReserve for learinig
CReserve for learinig
DReserve for learinig
ENGLISH
Moves the cursor for setting in TV menu
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
25
ENGLISH
CONTROLLING A MARANTZ DVD PLAYER (DVD)
• (*) RC101 dose not have the PRESET code library
for this key.
SOURCE ON/OFF Turns the DVD Player on and off
MENU/INPUTSelect the DVD menu
CH3/4–
ENTER
3(CURSOR)
4(CURSOR)
2(CURSOR)
1(CURSOR)
2
9
;
§
∞
6
5
DISC+/T.MODEDVD changer next disc (*)
AReserve for learinig
BReserve for learinig
CReserve for learinig
DReserve for learinig
Moves the cursor for setting in DVD
menu
Play
Stop
Pause
Skips to forward chapter/track
Skips to previous chapter/track
Searchs forward
Searchs backward
CONTROLLING A MARANTZ VCR DECK (VCR1/
VCR2)
• RC101 dose not have the PRESET code library for
this device.
SOURCE ON/OFF Turns the VCR deck on and off
MENU/INPUT–
CH3/4–
ENTER
3(CURSOR)
4(CURSOR)
2(CURSOR)
1(CURSOR)
2
9
;
§
∞
6
5
DISC+/T.MODE–
AReserve for learinig
BReserve for learinig
CReserve for learinig
DReserve for learinig
Moves the cursor for setting in VCR
menu
Play
Stop
Pause
Skips to forward track
Skips to previous track
Searchs forward
Searchs backward
CONTROLLING A MARANTZ SATELLITE
BROADCASTING TUNER (DSS)
• (*) RC101 dose not have the PRESET code library
for this key.
SOURCE ON/OFF
MENU/INPUTSelect the satellite tuner menu
CH3/4
ENTER
3(CURSOR)
4(CURSOR)
2(CURSOR)
1(CURSOR)
2
9
;
§
∞
6
5
DISC+/T.MODE–
AReserve for learinig
BReserve for learinig
CReserve for learinig
DReserve for learinig
Turns the satellite broadcasting tuner
on and off
Selects satellite tuner channel up or
down
Moves the cursor for setting in SATELLITE
Broadcasting TUNER menu
• RC101 dose not have the PRESET code library for
this device.
SOURCE ON/OFF Turns the Tuner on and off
MENU/INPUT–
CH3/4–
ENTER–
3(CURSOR)Tunes a frequency station up and down
4(CURSOR)Tunes a frequency station up and down
2(CURSOR)Selects a preset station up and down
1(CURSOR)Selects a preset station up and down
2
9
;
§
∞
6
5
DISC+/T.MODE
ASelects AM mode
BSelects FM mode
CSelects XM mode
DSelects DAB mode
Starts preset scan
Stop preset scan
–
–
–
–
–
Selects the auto stereo mode or mono
mode
26
ENGLISH
CONTROLLING A MARANTZ CD PLAYER (CD)
• (*) RC101 dose not have the PRESET code library
for this key.
SOURCE ON/OFF Turns the CD Player on and off
MENU/INPUT–
CH3/4–
ENTER–
3(CURSOR)–
4(CURSOR)–
2(CURSOR)–
1(CURSOR)–
2
9
;
§
∞
6
5
DISC+/T.MODECD changer next disc (*)
AReserve for learinig
BReserve for learinig
CReserve for learinig
DReserve for learinig
Play
Stop
Pause
Skips to forward track
Skips to previous track
Searchs forward
Searchs backward
CONTROLLING A MARANTZ CD RECORDER (CDR)
• RC101 dose not have the PRESET code library for
this device.
SOURCE ON/OFF Turns the CD Recorder on and off
MENU/INPUT–
CH3/4–
ENTER–
3(CURSOR)–
4(CURSOR)–
2(CURSOR)–
1(CURSOR)–
2
9
;
§
∞
6
5
DISC+/T.MODECDR changer next disc
AReserve for learinig
BReserve for learinig
CReserve for learinig
DReserve for learinig
Play
Stop
Pause
Skips to forward track
Skips to previous track
Searchs forward
Searchs backward
CONTROLLONG A MARANTZ TAPE DECK (TAPE)
• RC101 dose not have the PRESET code library for
this device.
SOURCE ON/OFF Turns the tape deck on and off
MENU/INPUT–
CH3/4–
ENTER–
3(CURSOR)–
4(CURSOR)–
2(CURSOR)–
1(CURSOR)–
2
9
;
§
∞
6
5
DISC+/T.MODE–
AReserve for learinig
BReserve for learinig
CReserve for learinig
DReserve for learinig
Play
Stop
Pause
Skips to forward track
Skips to previous track
Searchs forward
Searchs backward
CONTROLLING A MARANTZ UNIVERSAL DOCK
(AUX1)
• RC101 dose not have the PRESET code library for
this device.
SOURCE ON/OFF Turns the Universal Dock on and off
MENU/INPUTCall up the menu
CH3/4–
ENTER
3(CURSOR)
4(CURSOR)
2(CURSOR)
1(CURSOR)
2
9
;
§
∞
6
5
DISC+/T.MODEChange the userinterface mode
AReserve for learinig
BReserve for learinig
CReserve for learinig
DReserve for learinig
Moves the cursor for setting in Universal
dock menu
Play
Stop
Pause
Skips to forward track
Skips to previous track
Searchs forward
Searchs backward
27
ENGLISH
BASIC OPERATION
NORMAL MODE
(
When operating Marantz AV equipment products
This remote controller is preset with a total of
12 types of remote codes, including Marantz TV
(television), DVD, VCR (VCR deck), DSS (satellite
broadcasting tuner), TUNER 1, TUNER 2, CD, CD-R,
TAPE (tape deck), AUX1 and AUX2.
Learning is not necessary for Marantz products. You
can use these products without setting any codes.
1. Press the SOURCE button.
For this example, press DVD.
Pressing the SOURCE button once changes
the remote control to the settings for the source
that was pressed.
To change the amplifi er on other source, press
the SOURCE button twice (double-click). The
code is sent, and then the amplifi er source
changes to DVD.
SETTING THE BACK LIGHT
Each time press the buttons, illuminate button 2
seconds.
To turn off back light, press and hold down the SET
and 4 button until SEND indicator blinks twice.
To turn on it again, press and hold down the SET and
¢ button until SEND indicator blinks twice.
Initial is back light ON.
PRESET MODE
(When operating non-Marantz AV equipment
products)
This remote controller is preset with remote control
codes from AV equipment by other manufacturers.
The preset codes are TV, DVD, CD and DSS.
Settings can be made in one of two ways.
When the preset codes are set, the following codes
are contained in the source button of the remote
controller.
Importants:
• Some codes may be not match your equipment.
In this case, you can use LEARN mode to store these
)
codes.
• The preset codes do not cover full functions.
If you need extra function, use LEARN mode to
store extra function.
• When the batteries are getting weak, the preset
procedure is not successful.
PROGRAMMING WITH THE 4-DIGIT CODE
1.
1.
2.
1. Press and hold down the SOURCE button (ex
TV) for the appliance which should be controlled
and press SET button until the SEND indicator
blinks twice. Then back light fl ashes.
2. Press the 4-digit code by numeric keys for
appliance (code table at the end of this book)
When the procedure is successful, the
indicator will blink twice.
Note:
If the indicator did not blink twice, then repeat steps 1
through 2 and try entering the same code again.
SCANNING THE CODE TABLE
3.
5.
2.
3.
2.
SEND
4. Stop when the appliance turns off.
Press ENTER button once to lock in the code.
5.
CHECKING THE CODE
2.
4.
3.
1.
1. Press and hold down the SOURCE button for
appliance which should be controlled and press
SET button until the SEND indicator blinking twice
then back light fl ashes.
Press the INFO button.
2.
The SEND indicator will blink twice.
To view the code for fi rst digit, press 1 once.
3.
Count the SEND indicator blinks (e.g. 3 blinks =
3) and write down the number.
Note:
If a code digit is “0”, the SEND indicator will not
blink.
Repeat step 3 three more times for remaining
4.
digits. Use 2 for the second digit, 3 for the third
digit, and 4 for the fourth digit.
1.
RESETTING THE CODE
2.
1.
1.
2.
1. Press and hold down the SOURCE button
for appliance which should be controlled and
press SET button until the SEND indicator
blinking twice.
Then back light fl ashes.
Press the below codes to reset.
2.
TV : 1000
DVD : 2000
CD : 3000
DSS : 4000
The indicator will blink twice.
Note:
After this procedure, the selected SOURCE button is
set initial code.
See the attached manufacturer number list for the
preset manufacturers, devices, preset numbers, and
other settings.
Remote control
source name
TVTVTelevision
DVDDVDDVD player
CDCDCD player
DSSSATELLITESatellite broadcasting
Corresponding preset
code
Device name
tuner equipment
28
1. Switch on the appliance which should be
controlled.
Press and hold down the SOURCE button for
2.
appliance which should be controlled and press
SET button until the SEND indicator blinking
twice. Then back light fl ashes.
Aim the remote controller at the appliance and
3.
alternately press the CH+ and
buttons slowly.
SOURCE ON
LEARN MODE
This remote controller is capable of learning and
storing codes used by other remote controls that you
already own.
For codes which are not learned, the remote
controller will transmit either the Marantz preset
codes from the initial settings, or remote codes from
another manufacturer’s AV equipment which is set
by the customer.
The receiver sensor for the remote control signals is
located at the top of the remote controller.
Notes:
• This remote controller is capable to learn around 60
codes.
• When the batteries are getting weak , the learing
procedure is not successful.
LEARNING PROCEDURE
1. Place the remote controller so that its infrared
signal transmitter is facing the infrared signal
receiver on the Marantz remote controller at a
distance of about 2 inches (5 cm).
2 inches
S
Y
S
T
E
M
R
E
M
O
T
E
C
O
N
T
R
OL
L
ER
2. Press and hold down the SET and MENU/
INPUT buttons until LEARN indicator blinks.
4. Select the button to be learned.
• LEARN indicator lights up.
When the following key learned
• SOURCE buttons
The learning function is unavailable for all
SOURCE buttons in any mode.
• POWER ON button
• POWER OFF button
• VOL +/- button
• MUTE button
• INFO button
• SLEEP button
The above keys are common use in each
device mode. It can be learned in TV mode.
Press and hold the button of the original remote
5.
controller to learn until the SEND indicator
blinks twice.
• When the SEND indicator blinks once,
repeat this step.
• When the memory of the RC101 is full, the
LEARN and SEND indicators blink once.
If you want to learn the code, you should
erase other learned button.
Repeat steps 4 and 5 to learn other buttons in
6.
same SOURCE.
Repeat steps 3 to 6 to learn other SOURCE.
7.
When you have finished programming the
8.
remote controller, press the SET button, then
LEARN indicator stops blinking and exits from
the LEARN mode.
ERASING PROGRAMMED CODES (RETURNING TO
INITIAL SETTINGS)
Codes can be erased in three ways: by buttons,
sources, and by all memory contents.
Erasing the code by buttons
Press and hold down the SET and MENU/
1.
INPUT buttons until LEARN indicator blinks.
2. Select the SOURCE button to select the button
to be erased.
3. Press and hold down the SLEEP button and
press the learned button twice to be erased.
• SEND indicator blinks twice and the mode
returns to LEARN mode.
4. To return the NORMAL mode, press the SET
button.
Erasing the code by SOURCE
1. Press and hold down the SET and MENU/
INPUT buttons until LEARN indicator blinks.
3. Press ENTER button to continue erasing.
• The SEND indicator blinks twice and the
mode returns to LEARN mode.
• To cancel the erasing operation, do not
press ENTER button and simply touch any
other button.
4. To return the NORMAL mode, press the SET
button.
Erasing the all SOURCES
1. Press and hold down the SET and MENU/
INPUT buttons until LEARN indicator blinks.
2. Press and hold down the SLEEP button and
press POWER ON and POWER OFF button.
• LEARN indicator lights.
3. Press ENTER button to continue erasing.
• The SEND indicator blinks twice and the
mode returns to LEARN mode.
• To cancel the erasing operation, do not
press ENTER button and simply touch any
other button.
ENGLISH
3. Select the SOURCE button to select the
SOURCE.
Notes:
• When the SEND indicator blinks once again, the
transmitting code is unavailable for RC101, or the
transmitting signal is intercepted by noise.
• If no buttons are pressed for approximately 1
minutes while in the LEARN mode, the remote
controller automatically exits from the LEARN
mode.
2. Press and hold down the SLEEP button and
press the learned SOURCE button twice to be
erased.
• LEARN indicator lights.
4. To return the NORMAL mode, press the SET
button.
Note:
Erasing codes will return to the factory preset code,
or there will leave empty if the button has no factory
preset code.
29
ENGLISH
CLONE MODE
Creating copies using clone mode
All of the codes programmed to the RC101 remote
controller can be copied to another RC101 using a
few simple operations.
• The remote controller can copy the entire
contents.
• When copying the entire contents, all programmed
codes are copied.
Note:
The clone function can only be used for copying
when using the same model (RC101) for both the
transmitting and receiving remote controller.
Copying entire contents
1. Place the receiver sensor of the receiving
remote controller (top) so that it is facing the
transmitter of the transmitting remote controller
(top) at a distance of about 2 inches (5 cm).
2 inches
S
Y
S
T
E
M
R
E
M
O
TE
C
O
N
T
R
O
L
L
E
R
2. Press SET button and PLAY button of the
transmitting remote controller until the SEND
indicator blinks twice.
4. Press the ENTER cursor button on the receiving
remote controller.
OTHER OPERATIONS
CHANGE THE CONTROL COMMANDS OF MULTI
SPEAKER FUNCTION FROM MULTI ROOM.
CHANGE THE MULTI ROOM CONTROL COMMANDS
FOR EACH ZONE
(When operating the unit by Multi Zone connected)
Then back lights tune off.
• Zone A: MULTI ROOM A Control (Default)
• Zone B: MULTI ROOM B Control
(The SR7002 does not use this zone.)
• Zone C: The unit does not use this zone.
1.
2.
• Zone D: MAIN ROOM
5. Press the ENTER cursor button on the
Change the control commands for each zone.
transmitting remote controller.
2.
1.
Then backlights tune off.
1. Press SET button and POWER ON button until
the SEND indicator blinks twice.
Then backlight fl ashes.
2. Press the 1-digit code by numeric keys.
• Multi room mode: 1 (Default)
R
E
L
L
O
R
T
N
O
C
E
T
O
M
6. When copying is started, the SEND indicator of
E
R
M
E
T
YS
S
transmitting remote controller and the LEARN
indicator of receiving remote controller start to
blink.
When the copying operation is completed, the
back lights of transmitting remote controller and
receiving remote controller are turned on.
Do not touch either of the remote controls
during the copying operation. Doing so could
cause copying to fail.
If the copying fails in the middle of the copying
process, back light of receiving remote are
flash. Press the SET button to return the
normal mode. Check and perform steps 1 to 5
again.
Copying takes about 30 seconds to complete
when the transmitting remote controller has
been programmed to 100% capacity.
1. Press SET button and ZONE button until the
SEND indicator blinks twice.
Then backlight fl ashes.
2. Press each zone button(A/B button)
When the procedure is successful, the SEND
indicator will blink twice.
These buttons change a special code of each zone.
POWER ON/OFF
SOURCE
• Multi speaker mode: 2
Note
In case of Zone D, only control for main room is
possible.
3. Press ENTER button once to lock in the code.
When the procedure is successful, the SEND
indicator will blink twice.
These buttons change a special code of multi room
mode or multi speaker mode.
Note
The control commands can be set independently in
ZONE A/B.
POWER ON/OFF
3.
1.
Then backlight fl ashes
The transmitting side is now ready.
3. Press SET button and STOP button of the
receiving remote controller until the LEARN
indicator blinks twice.
Then backlight fl ashes.
The receiving side is now ready.
30
7. Once copying is completed, press the SET
button on both remote controls.
VOL +/–
MUTE
INFO
SLEEP
Tuner mode operation remote code (Refer to p.26)
VOL +/–
MUTE
CONNECTIONS
SPEAKER PLACEMENT
The ideal surround speaker system for this unit is 7speaker systems, using front left and right speakers,
a center speaker, surround left and right speakers,
a surround back left and right speakers, and a
subwoofer.
For best results we recommend that all front speakers
be of the same type, with identical or similar driver
units. This will deliver smooth pans across the front
sound stage as the action moves from side to side.
Your center channel speaker is very important as
over 80 % of the dialog from a typical motion picture
emanates from the center channel.
It should possess similar sonic characteristics to the
main speakers. Surround channel speakers need not
be identical to the front channel speakers, but they
should be of high quality.
The surround center speaker is useful for playback
of Dolby Digital Surround EX or DTS-ES. One of
the benefi ts of both Dolby Digital and DTS is that
surround channels are discrete full range, while they
were frequency limited in earlier “Pro Logic” type
systems.
Bass effects are an important part of home theater.
For optimal enjoyment a subwoofer should be used
as it is optimized for low frequency reproduction. If you
have full range front speakers, however, they may be
used in place of a subwoofer with proper setting of the
switches in the menu system.
Surround Left
Surround Back
Left
Surround Back
Right
150°
135°
Surround Right
110°
Front left and right speakers
We recommend to set the front L and R speakers
with 45-60 degrees from the listening position.
Center speaker
Align the front line of the center speaker with the front
L/R speakers. Or place the center speaker a little
backward from the line.
Subwoofer
Front Left
Front Center
0°
22°
30°
90°
Front Right
Surround left and right speakers
When this unit is used in surround operation, the
preferred location for surround speakers is on the
side walls of the room, at or slightly behind the
listening position.
The center of the speaker should face into the room.
Surround back left and right speakers
Surround back speakers are required when a full 7.1channel system is installed.
Speakers should be placed on a rear wall, behind the
listening position.
The center of the speaker should face into the room.
Subwoofer
We recommend using a sub-woofer to have maximum
bass effect. As the subwoofer only handle low frequency.
You can place it any where in the room.
HEIGHT OF THE SPEAKER UNITS
Front left and right speakers, and a center speaker
Align the tweeters and mid-range drivers on the
three front speakers at the same height, as best as
possible.
Surround left and right speakers, and surround
back speaker
Place the surround left, right and surround back
speakers higher than your ears by about 70cm–1m.
Also place the speakers at the same height, as best
as possible.
70cm
1m
Note:
• Use magnetically-shielded speakers for front left,
right and the center speakers when the speakers are
installed near the TV.
CONNECTING SPEAKERS
Passive
subwoofer
Power
Amplifi er
INVERT
INPUT
INPUT
BTL REMOTE CONT.EXT. CONT. IN
OUTPUT
LEVEL
MASTERSLAVE
MIN MAX
VIDEO/
SYSTEM OUT OUT
+5~13V DC
S
U
F
SPEAKER SYSTEM
MINIMUM 4 OHMS
IN
E
CONNECTING SPEAKER WIRE
1. Strip away approx. 3/8 inch (10 mm) of wire
insulation.
Twist the bared wire ends tight, to prevent short
2.
circuits.
Loosen the knob by turning it counterclockwise.
3.
4. Insert the bare part of the wire into the hole in
side of each terminal.
Tighten the knob by turning it clockwise to
5.
secure the wire.
Powered
subwoofer
Surround
Right
BACK
Left
FRONT A
Right
RightLeft
Surround
Left
1.2.
3/8 inch
(10 mm)
3.4.5.
FRONT B
Right
Center
ENGLISH
Left
31
ENGLISH
Caution:
•
Be sure to use speakers with the specifi ed impedance as
shown on the rear panel of this unit.
•
To prevent damage to circuitry, do not let the bare
speaker wires touch each other and do not let them
touch any metal part of this unit.
CONNECTING AUDIO COMPONENTS
CD recorder
OUT IN
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
INPUT
LRL
R
OUTPUT
OUT IN
LRL
L R
Tape Deck
R
L R
• Do not touch the speaker terminals when the
power is on. It may cause you to receive an electric
shocks.
• Do not connect more than one speaker cable to one
speaker terminal. Doing so may damage this unit.
Note:
Be sure to connect the positive and negative cables for
•
the speaker properly. If they are miss-connected, the
signal phase will be reversed and the signal quality will
be corrupted.
CONNECTING A SUBWOOFER
Use the PRE OUT SUBWOOFER jack to connect a
powered subwoofer (power amplifi er built in ).
If your subwoofer is a passive type (power amplifi er
is not built in), connect a monaural power amplifi er to
the PRE OUT SUBWOOFER jack and connect the
subwoofer to the amplifi er.
R L
RL
The output audio signal from the TAPE OUT jack and
the CD/CD RECORDER OUT jack is the same signal
which is currently selected.
Caution:
• Do not connect this unit and other components
to mains power until all connections between
components have been completed.
Notes:
• Insert all plugs and connectors securely. Incomplete
connections may make noise.
• Be sure to connect the left and right channels
properly.
Red connectors are for the R (right) channel, and
white connectors are for the L (left) channel.
• Be sure to connect input and output properly.
• Refer to the instructions for each component that is
connected to this unit.
• Do not bind audio/video connection cables with
power cords and speaker cables this will result in
generating a hum or other noise.
RLRL
R L R L
Analog Audio
L R
Digital Audio (coaxial)
Digital Audio (optical)
CONNECTING DIGITAL AUDIO COMPONENTS
• There are 6 digital inputs, 3 coaxial jacks and
3 optical jacks, on the rear panel. You can use
these jacks to input PCM, Dolby Digital and DTS
bitstream signals from a CD, DVD, or other digital
source components.
• There is one digital output coaxial jack and one
optical output jack on the rear panel. These jacks
can be connected to a CD recorder, or a MD deck
inputs, respectively.
• Refer to the instructions for each component. To
setup the digital audio format of DVD player, or
other digital source’s connected to digital input
jacks.
• Use fi ber optical cables (optical) for DIG-1,2,3
input jacks. Use 75 ohms coaxial cables (for digital
audio or video) for DIG-4, 5, 6 input jacks.
• You can designate the input for each digital input/
output jacks according to your component. See
page 43.
Notes:
• There is no Dolby Digital RF input jack. Use an
external RF demodulator Dolby Digital decoder
when connecting the Dolby Digital RF output jack
of the videodisc player to the digital input jack.
• The digital signal jacks on this unit conform to
the EIA standard. If you use a cable that does not
conform to this standard, this unit may not function
properly.
• Each type of audio jack works independently.
Signals input through the digital and analog jacks are
output through the corresponding digital and analog
jacks, respectively.
32
CONNECTING VIDEO COMPONENTS
DVD player
DIGITAL
OUT
AUDIO
OUT
LR
L R
VIDEO
OUT
L R L RLR
LLRR
AUDIO
OUT
LR
AUDIO
IN
LR
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
YC
B
/ PBCR
/ PR
OUT IN
VIDEO
S-VIDEO
OUT
S-VIDEO
OUT IN
COMPONENT
VIDEO IN
YC
B
/ PBCR
/ PR
S-VIDEO
IN
VCR
VIDEO
PROJECTOR
DIGITAL
OUT
L R
AUDI O
OUT
LR
VIDEO, S-VIDEO, COMPONENT JACKS
There are 3 types of video jacks on the rear panel.
Satellite Tuner
AUDI O
OUT
LR
L R
LR
VIDEO
LR
OUT
S-VIDEO
OUT
Video
S-Video
Analog Audio
L R
VIDEO
OUT
VIDEO
IN
S-VIDEO
IN
Digital Audio
(coaxial)
Digital Audio
(optical)
TV
VIDEO jack
The video signal for the VIDEO jacks is the
conventional composite video signal.
S-VIDEO jack
The video signal is separated into luminance (Y) and
color (C) signals for the S-VIDEO jack. The S-VIDEO
signals enables high-quality color reproduction. If
your video component has an S-VIDEO output, we
recommend to use it. Connect the S-VIDEO output
jack on your video component to the S-VIDEO input
jack on this unit.
Component jack
Make component video connections to a TV or
monitor with component inputs to produce higher
quality video images. Use a component video cable
or 3 video cords to connect the component video out
jacks on the unit to the monitor.
Notes:
Be sure to connect the left and right audio channels
•
properly.
Red connectors are for the R (right) channel, and
white connectors are the for L (left) channel.
• Be sure to connect the inputs and outputs of the
video signals properly.
If you connect the S-VIDEO or component signal to
•
the S-VIDEO or component jack on this unit, it is not
necessary to connect the conventional video signal to
the VIDEO (composite) jack. If you use both video
inputs, this unit gives priority to the S-VIDEO signal.
• Each type of video jack works independently.
Signals input to the VIDEO (composite) and SVIDEO jacks or component are output to the
corresponding VIDEO (composite) and S-VIDEO
or component jacks, respectively.
T
his unit
•
has the “TV-AUTO ON/OFF” function to
turn the TV ON or OFF automatically, by sensing the
incoming video signal from the VIDEO jacks.
• You may need to setup the digital audio output
format of your DVD player, or other digital source
components. Refer to the instructions of the each
component connected to the digital input jacks.
• There is no Dolby Digital RF input jack. Use an
external RF demodulator with a Dolby Digital
decoder to connect the Dolby Digital RF output jack
of the DVD player to the digital input jack on this
unit.
• The COMPONENT OUTPUT 1 and 2 terminals of
this unit can output the same video signal. Moreover,
the OUTPUT 2 terminal of the SR8002 can output
video signals for multi room playback. (See page
53)
ENGLISH
33
ENGLISH
CONNECTING HDMI COMPONENTS
DVD playerVIDEO PROJECTOR
HDMI JACK
This unit has four HDMI inputs and two HDMI output.
It can send digital video and audio signals from DVDs
and other sources directly to a display. It minimizes
signal degradation caused by analog conversion so
that high quality images can be enjoyed.
This unit is also capable of converting analog video
signals (Composite Video, S-Video, Component
Video) for HDMI output.
Select an input source from the OSD menu system.
(See page 43, 44)
Notes:
• When the HDMI output is connected to a display
monitor that does not support HDCP, signals are not
output. To view images in HDMI, it is necessary to
connect to a display that supports HDCP.
• There may be no image output if connected to a
TV or display that is not compatible with the above
format.
• Refer to the instruction manual of the TV or display
to be connected to the unit for detailed information
regarding the HDMI terminal.
* HDCP: High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection
CONNECTING HDMI COMPONENTS
An HDMI cable (sold separately) is used to connect
the HDMI jack on the unit with the HDMI jack on a DVD
player, TV, projector or other component. To transmit
multichannel audio via HDMI, the connected player
must support multichannel audio transmission through
its HDMI jack.
HDMI video streaming is compatible with DVI in
principle. Therefore, it is possible to connect to a TV
or monitor that has a DVI terminal using an HDMI-DVI
conversion cable or plug. When connecting to a DVI
terminal, connect the audio signal separately.
Notes:
• Some HDMI components can be controlled over
the HDMI cable, but this unit cannot control other
components this way.
• When connected to a monitor (i.e., TV, projector,
etc.) that does not support HDCP, video and audio
are not output.
• DVI cables come with 24-pin and 29-pin plugs. This
unit supports 24-pin DVI-D cables; 29-pin DVI
cables cannot connect to it.
• Some source devices such as DVD players or set
top box do not support HDMI repeater operations
like those of the unit. In such case, pictures are not
properly projected on monitors such as TVs and
projectors.
• When multiple components are connected to this
unit, turn power to unused components off to
prevent interference between them.
• Disconnecting or connecting cables with the power
on can damage the equipment. Turn the power off
before disconnecting or connecting cables.
• Some DVD-Audio disks disable downmixing.
These types of disks are not played back correctly
unless the left, center, right and surround left and
right speakers, and subwoofer are connected.
• If a DVD player that does not support HDMI 1.1 or
later is connected to the unit, multi channel PCM
playback is not possible even with DVD-Audio
disks.
• If an Super Audio CD player that does not support
HDMI 1.2 or later is connected to the unit, DSD
playback is not possible even with Super Audio
CD.
(*DSD: Direct Stream Digital)
• The following functions are not available when the
unit is connected to equipment that does not support
HDMI 1.3a.
• Deep Color
• xvYCC
• Bitstream audio signal decoding, as for Dolby
Digital Plus, Dolby TrueHD, DTS-HD, and so on
For details, refer to the user’s manuals of connected
equipment.
• If a DVD player or other device with DVI output is
connected to the unit, a separate audio cable (opticaldigital, coaxial digital or analog) is needed for the
audio signals. In this case, select the connected audio
input as explained in “1-1 FUNC INPUT SETUP”.
(See page 43)
• Multi channel PCM signals and audio signals of 64
kHz or higher that are input from the HDMI jack are
not output from the DIGITAL OUT jacks.
• Depending on the quiality of the cable used, the
HDMI signal may be affected by noise.
HDMI OUTPUTHDMI INPUT
SATELLITE TUNER
HDMI OUTPUT
34
ADVANCED CONNECTING
DVD Audio player
or
Super Audio CD
Multi channel player
SURR.
BACK
CENTER
SUB
WOOFER
L
R
FRONT SURR.
CONNECTING THE REMOTE CONTROL JACKS
ENGLISH
LR
LRLR
R L
R L
Power
Amplifer
Subwoofer
L
R
FRONT SURR.
R L
SURR.
BACK
CENTER
SUB
WOOFER
1
2
RC OUT
OPTION
RLRLRL
RLRLRL
CONNECTING MULTI CHANNEL AUDIO SOURCE
The 7.1CH INPUT jacks are for multichannel audio
source such as a Super Audio CD multichannel
player, DVD audio player or external decoder.
If you use these jacks, switch on the 7.1CH INPUT
and set the 7.1CH INPUT level by using the SETUP
MAIN MENU. See page 43.
Center
Surround
Front
Right
Right
Surround
Back Right
Front
Left
Surround
Left
Surround
Back Left
CONNECTING AN EXTERNAL POWER AMPLIFIER
The PREOUT jacks are for connecting external
power amplifi ers.
Be sure to connect each speaker to the corresponding
external power amplifi er.
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
OUT
CD recorder
EXTERNAL INTERNAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
OUT
q
You can control other Marantz products through this
unit with the remote controller by connecting the
REMOTE CONTROL terminals on each unit.
The signal transmitted from the remote controller
is received by the remote sensor on this unit. Then
the signal is sent to the connected device through
this terminal. Therefore you need to aim the remote
control only at the unit. Also, if a Marantz power
amplifi er (some models excluded) is connected to
one of these terminals, the power amplifi er’s, power
switch is synchronized with this unit’s power switch.
Set the REMOTE CONTROL SWITCH on the
back of other units (not the SR7002/8002) to “EXT.”
(EXTERNAL) to use this feature.
DVD player
EXTERNAL INTERNAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
OUT
CD player
EXTERNAL INTERNAL
w
Whenever external infrared sensors or similar devices
are connected to RC-5 IN of the unit, be sure to
always disable operation of the infrared sensor on the
unit by using the following procedure.
1. Hold down the MULTI button and the MENU
button on the front panel at the same time for
fi ve seconds.
The setting “IR=ENABLE” is shown on the FL
2.
DISPLAY.
Press the CURSOR buttons (1, 2) to change
3.
this to “IR=DISABLE”.
Press the ENTER button. Once this setting
4.
is made, the infrared sensor on the unit is
disabled.
Note:
• Be sure to set to “IR=ENABLE” when external
infrared sensors or similar devices are not connected.
Otherwise, the unit will be unable to receive remote
control commands.
To restore the original setting, perform steps 1
5.
to 4 to set to “IR=ENABLE”.
35
ENGLISH
ANTANTENNA
CONNECTING THE ANTENNA TERMINALS
FM Feeder Antenna
(For SR8002)
FM Antenna
(For SR7002)
Antenna
Converter
(SR8002 Only)
ASSEMBLING THE AM LOOP ANTENNA
1.
Release the vinyl tie and take out the connection
line.
2. Bend the base part in the reverse direction.
3. Insert the hook at the bottom of the loop part
into the slot at the base part.
FM External
Antenna
AM External
AM Loop
Antenna
4. Place the antenna on stable surface.
Antenna
CONNECTING THE ANTENNA WIRE TO THE
ANTENNA CONVERTER
Loosen the screws and attach the wire terminals,
then tighten the screws with a screwdriver.
CONNECTING THE SUPPLIED ANTENNAS
Connecting the supplied FM antenna
The supplied FM antenna is for indoor use only.
During use, extend the antenna and move it in various
directions until the clearest signal is received.
Fix it with push pins or similar implements in
the position that will cause the least amount of
distortion.
If you experience poor reception quality, an outdoor
antenna may improve the quality.
Connecting the supplied AM loop antenna
The supplied AM loop antenna is for indoor use
only.
Set it in the direction and position it to where you
receive the clearest sound. Put it as far away as
possible from the unit, televisions, speaker cables,
and power cords.
If you experience poor reception quality, an outdoor
antenna may improve the quality.
Press and hold down the lever of the AM antenna
1.
terminal.
2. Insert the bare wire into the antenna terminal.
Release the lever.
3.
Note:
• Connect the shielded grounding wire (black) to the
AM antenna GND terminal.
CONNECTING AN FM OUTDOOR ANTENNA
Notes:
• Keep the antenna away from noise sources (neon
signs, busy roads, etc.).
• Do not put the antenna close to power lines. Keep it
well away from power lines, transformers, etc.
• To avoid the risk of lightning and electrical shock,
grounding is necessary.
CONNECTING AN AM OUTDOOR ANTENNA
An outdoor antenna will be more effective if it is
stretched horizontally above a window or outside.
Notes:
• Do not remove the AM loop antenna.
• To avoid the risk of lightning and electrical shock,
grounding is necessary.
36
XM RADIO OVERVIEW
XM
This unit is the XM Ready® receiver. You can receive XM Satellite Radio® by connecting to the XM Mini-Tuner
and Home Dock (sold separately) and subscribing the XM service.
Introducing XM Satellite Radio
There’s a world of audio listening pleasure beyond AM and FM. XM Satellite Radio which includes:
• Over 170 Digital Channels
• The most commercial-free music in satellite radio
• Live concerts plus exclusive original programming
• The biggest names in news, talk, and entertainment
• The most sports play-by-play
• Major league Baseball. Every team. All season long.
Listeners can subscribe by visiting XM on the Web at www.xmradio.com or by calling XM’s Listener Care at
(800) 967-2346. Customers should have their Radio ID and credit card ready. The Radio ID can be found by
selecting channel 0 on the radio.
(See the “CHECKING THE XM SIGNAL STRENGTH AND RADIO ID”)
A Warning Against Reverse Engineering
It is prohibited to copy, decompile, disassemble, reverse engineer, or manipulate any technology incorporated
in receivers compatible with the XM Satellite Radio system.
Furthermore, the AMBE
property rights including patent rights, copyrights, and trade secrets of Digital Voice Systems, Inc. The user of
this or any other software contained in an XM Radio is explicitly prohibited from attempting to copy, decompile,
reverse engineer, or disassemble the object code, or in any other way convert the object code into humanreadable form. The software is licensed solely for use within this product.
®
voice compression software included in this product is protected by intellectual
CONNECTING THE XM CONNECT-AND-PLAY ANTENNA
• Plug the XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock into XM terminal on the rear panel.
• Position the XM antenna near a south-facing window to receive the best signal.
When making connections, also refer to the operating instructions of the XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock.
XMXMXM
ON
MULTI SPEAKER
/SPEAKER C
SUB SPEAKER : 6-8 OHMS
Note
• Keep the power supply cord unplugged until the XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock connection have been
completed.
A bi-amp connection is possible with speakers that
have two sets of inputs (for treble and bass).
This allows you to drive the treble and bass units
with separate channel amps, which enables better
sound quality. Connect the speakers as shown in the
fi gure. Set the SPEAKER C selector switch on the
rear panel to ON.
Notes:
• If incorrectly connected, a protective circuit in
the unit will trip and set the unit to standby. (The
STANDBY indicator will flash.) In such case,
recheck the connections between the speakers and
the unit.
• Turn power to the unit off before changing the
setting of the SPEAKER C selector switch.
38
MULTIROOM B
IR RECEIVER
L RLR
R L
FRONT
MULTIROOM
LEFT
SPEAKER
R L
L
R
FRONTRC IN
IR RECEIVER
RC OUT
L
R
VIDEO
IN
MAIN AMP
(For multiroom)
MULTIROOM
MONITOR
RIGHT
SPEAKER
RIGHT
SPEAKER
LEFT
SPEAKER
Note:
Note:
The SR7002 does not use MULTIROOM B.
• You can use surround back speaker terminals as
MULTI SPK. terminals or SPEAKER C terminal
when you are not using surround back speakers.
CONNECTING OTHER EQUIPMENT
gsafd
ENGLISH
a RS232C
Connect an external control device or other device for
servicing. (Use a straight cable for the connection.)
s DC OUT (DC TRIGGER)
External devices can be controlled from the unit
by connecting them to the DC OUT terminal (12 V
44mA max).
d EMITTER OUT (SR8002 Only)
Outputs the remote control signal input to the IR
RECEIVER IN terminals. External components can
be controlled by connecting them to the EMITTER
OUT terminal.
f FLASHER IN
This unit can be controlled by connecting a control
box or other control device to this unit.
g IR RECEIVER IN (SR8002 Only)
This unit can be operated by remote controller
without using the internal IR receiver, by connecting
an external IR receiver.
GND
+12V
Signal
An IR receiver is connected as shown above.
Caution:
• Wrongly connecting an IR receiver or connecting
an IR receiver of the wrong voltage can damage the
unit, therefore do not do this.
• 50 mA of current are supplied to the device connected
to the IR RECEIVER IN terminal.
• Connecting a device that requires more than 50
mA of current to this unit will damage this unit.
Before using other devices, carefully check the
specifi cations of those devices.
39
ENGLISH
MULTI
AMP
AUX2
AUX1
TAPE
TUNER
CD
CD-R
MD
12
LIGHT
Learning Remote Controller
RC8001SR
SETUP
After all components are connected, initial setup
must be performed.
ONSCREEN DISPLAY MENU SYSTEM
This unit incorporates an onscreen menu system,
which makes various operations possible by using
the cursor (3, 4, 1 , 2) and OK/ENTER buttons on
the remote controller or on the front panel.
Note:
To view the onscreen displays, make certain you
•
have connected the MONITOR OUT jack on the rear
panel to the composite, S-Video, component video
or HDMI input of your TV or projector. (See page
33, 34)
1. Press the AMP button on the remote controller.
(This step is not needed when operating the
setup menus from the unit.)
Press the MENU button on the remote controller
2.
or press the MENU button on the front panel.
The “MAIN MENU” of the OSD menu system is
displayed.
There are 6 items in the MAIN MENU.
Select the desired sub-menu with the 3
3.
4 cursor buttons and press the OK/ENTER
button. The display will change to the selected
sub-menu.
Notes:
• If you desire to adjust any sub-menu, you need to set
it to UNLOCKED.
• To lock sub-menus, set items 1-6 on the MAIN
MENU to “LOCKED”.
<LOCKING SUBMENUS>
(1) Move the cursor to “1. INPUT SETUP” in the
MAIN MENU.
(2) Select the “0” mark left of “LOCKED” with the 1
or 2 cursor buttons.
To exit from OSD menu system, press the EXIT
4.
button, or move the cursor to EXIT and press
the OK/ENTER button.
Note:
• Settings are entered with the ENTER button on
the unit or the OK button on the remote controller.
When using the remote controller, use the OK
button as if it were the ENTER button.
40
or
RC8001SR BUTTON CONTROL
CH
LEFT button
OK button
PREV
MENU
TEST
MENU button
7.1CH
Press this button to display
the OSD menu system.
SR7002/SR8002 FRONT BUTTON CONTROL
AUTO
MULTIT-MODE
7.1CH INPUT
LEFT button
THX
MENU
MENU button
Press this button to display the
OSD menu system.
OK
LIP·SYNC
GUIDE
CH.SEL
231
ATT
UP button
SPEAKER
ENTER
DOWN button
BAND
VOL
MUTE
EXIT
SURR
SPK-AB
ENTER button
MEMORY
DISPLAY
M-DAX
EXIT
MIC
EXIT button
Press this button to exit the
OSD menu system.
UP button
RIGHT button
DOWN button
EXIT button
Press this button to exit the OSD
menu system.
AMP (Amplifi er) button
RIGHT button
Note:
• After you complete this portion of the setup, move
cursor to “RETURN” with the 3, 4, 1 and 2
cursor buttons and press the OK/ENTER button.
MAIN MENU
MAIN MENU
1.INPUT SETUP
2.SPKR SETUP
3.SURR SETUP LOCKED
4.VIDEO SETUP
5.PREFERENCE UNLOCK
6.ACOUSTIC EQ
ENGLISH
1.INPUT SETUP
FUNC INPUT SETUP
7.1CH INPUT SETUP
FUNCTION RENAME
RETURN NEXTEXIT
“1. INPUT SETUP” (P. 42)
2.SPKR SETUP
AUTO SETUP
MANUAL SETUP
THX AUDIO SETUP
RETURN NEXTEXIT
3.SURR SETUP
CHANNEL LEVEL
PL x MUSIC PARAMETER
CS PARAMETER
NEO:6 PARAMETER
RE-EQ : OFF
LFE LEVEL : -10dB
M-DAX : OFF
RETURN NEXTEXIT
“3. SURROUND SETUP” (P. 51)
4.VIDEO SETUP
VIDEO CONVERT
TV.AUTO :DISABLE
OSD INFO :ENABLE
I/P CONVERT :DISABLE
HDMI OUT :OUTPUT1
COMPO OUT2 :MAIN
SUB MENU
5.PREFERENCE
MULTI ROOM SETUP A B
DC TRIGGER SETUP 1 2
STANDBY : NORMAL
BILINGUAL : MAIN
HDMI AUDIO: ENABLE
HDMI LIP : ENABLE
RETURN NEXTEXIT
“5. PREFERENCE” (P. 54)
Note:
• The SR7002 does not have “MULTI ROOM
SETUP” A and B selection options.
6.ACOUSTIC EQ.
EQ.MODE : OFF
PRESET G.EQ ADJ
CHECK AUTO
RETURN NEXTEXIT
“2. SPEAKER SETUP” (P. 45)
RETURN NEXTEXIT
“4. VIDEO SETUP” (P. 53)
Note:
• The SR7002 does not have “COMPO OUT2”
Sub-menus.
RETURN NEXTEXIT
“6. ACOUSTIC EQ” (P. 56)
41
ENGLISH
1 INPUT SETUP
This menu is for setting the matching the output of
connected audio devices and the input jacks of this
unit.
1.INPUT SETUP
FUNC INPUT SETUP
7.1CH INPUT SETUP
FUNCTION RENAME
•
FUNC INPUT SETUP :
“1-1 FUNC INPUT SETUP” (see page 43)
•
7.1 CH INPUT SETUP :
“1-2 7.1 CH INPUT SETUP” (see page 43)
•
FUNC RENAME :
“1-3 FUNCTION RENAME” (see page 44)
Select “1. INPUT SETUP” from the MAIN
1.
MENU with 3
or
4 cursor button, and press the
OK/ENTER button.
1.INPUT SETUP
FUNC INPUT SETUP
7.1CH INPUT SETUP
FUNCTION RENAME
RETURN NEXTEXIT
2. Select the desired sub-menu with the 3
4 cursor buttons, and press the OK/ENTER
button.
or
P. 43
☞
FUNC INPUT SETUP 1
FUNC:MODE DIG HDMI COMP V/S
TV :AUTO 11 11
DVD :AUTO2222
VCR1:AUTO3333
DSS :AUTO4444
AUX1:AUTOF--
RETURN NEXTT EXIT
FUNC INPUT SETUP 2
FUNC:MODE DIG HDMI C0MP V/S
TAPE:ANA- - - 1
CD/R:AUTO5 - -2
AUX2:ANA- - -3
RETURN BACK EXIT
RETURN NEXTEXIT
P. 43
☞
7.1CH INPUT SETUP
VIDEO-IN : LAST
FRONT L : 0dB
CENTER : 0dB
FRONT R : 0dB
SURR.R : 0dB
SURR.B R : 0dB
SURR.B L : 0dB
SURR. L : 0dB
SUB W : 0dB
RETURN NEXTEXIT
P. 44
☞
FUNCTION RENAME
FUNCTION: TV
RENAME : TV________
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUV
WXYZabcdefghijklmnopqr
stuvwxyz0123456789!"#$
%&’()*+,../:;<=>?
_{|}SPACE BACK DEFAULT
RETURN NEXTEXIT
__
42
1-1 FUNC INPUT SETUP
(ASSIGNABLE DIGITAL INPUT)
The 6 and F (Front) digital inputs can be assigned to
a desired source.
HDMI and COMPONENT inputs can be assigned to
the preferred source.
Use this menu to select which digital input jacks are
to be assigned to which input source.
Select “FUNC INPUT SETUP” from the
1.
1.INPUT SETUP menu with the 3
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button.
FUNC INPUT SETUP 1
FUNC:MODE DIG HDMI COMP V/S
TV :AUTO 11 11
DVD :AUTO2222
VCR1:AUTO3333
DSS :AUTO4444
AUX1:AUTOF--
RETURN NEXTT EXIT
2. Select a setting with the 3, 4, 1, and 2 cursor
buttons, and assign a mode and input jack
(DIG, HDMI, COMP, V/S).
MODE
AUTO:
Select “AUTO”, for automatic detection of the
digital input signal condition.
If there is no digital signal, but there is an analog
signal present, the analog signal will be played.
"AUTO" is the initial setting of all input sources.
HDMI:
Select “HDMI”
used
.
DIG:
Select “DIG”, when only a digital signal will be
used.
ANA:
Select “ANA” for input sources for which no digital
input jacks are used.
DIG
6 and F(Front) digital inputs can be assigned to a
desired source.
Assign the number of a digital input jack to the
device.
, when only a HDMI signal will be
or
4 cursor
HDMI
Assign the number of an HDMI input jack to the
device.
Note:
• When FUNCTION MODE is set to HDMI and
HDMI AUDIO of “5. PREFERENCE” is set to
THROUGH, audio is not output from the unit. (See
page 54)
COMP
Assign the number of a component video input
jack to the device.
V/S
Assign the number of a composite video and Svideo input jack to the device.
Note:
• Video and S-video can use the same numbers when
assigning to input functions.
• The ✽ mark in AUX.1 indicates that other inputs
cannot be assigned.
Press the OK/ENTER button.
3.
Select each mode setting and input terminal
4.
with the 1
Press the OK/ENTER button.
5.
Repeat steps 2-5 until all items are set.
6.
After you complete this portion of the setup,
7.
move the cursor to “NEXT” with the 3, 4, 1,
and 2 cursor buttons and then press the OK/
ENTER button to go to the next page.
Repeat steps 2-5 until all items are set.
8.
After you complete this portion of the setup,
move the cursor to “RETURN” with 3, 4, 1,
and 2 cursor buttons and press the OK/ENTER
button.
To return to the Func Input Setup 1 menu from
the Func Input Setup 2 menu, move the cursor
to “BACK” with the 3, 4, 1 , and 2 cursor
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button.
Note:
• Assignments cannot be made in sections with a ✽
mark.
or
2 cursor buttons.
FUNC INPUT SETUP 2
FUNC:MODE DIG HDMI C0MP V/S
TAPE:ANA- - - 1
CD/R:AUTO5 - -2
AUX2:ANA- - -3
RETURN BACK EXIT
1-2 7.1 CH INPUT SETUP
This menu is for adjusting the speaker levels for 7.1channel input sources.
Here you will adjust the volume for each channel so
that they are all heard by the listener at the same
level.
1. Select “7.1 CH INPUT SETUP” from the
1.INPUT SETUP menu with the 3
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button.
7.1CH INPUT SETUP
VIDEO-IN : LAST
FRONT L : 0dB
CENTER : 0dB
FRONT R : 0dB
SURR.R : 0dB
SURR.B R : 0dB
SURR.B L : 0dB
SURR. L : 0dB
SUB W : 0dB
RETURN NEXTEXIT
Select “VIDEO-IN” with the 3
2.
buttons.
Using the 1
3.
video input source to be played through the
MONITOR OUT jack.
The input source is switched by pressing the
or
1
LAST ↔ TV ↔ DVD ↔ VCR1 ↔ DSS ↔
AUX1 ↔ V-OFF ↔ LAST↔...
Notes:
•
When “LAST” is selected, the source is set to the
source selected before the 7.1 ch input menu was
activated.
• When
MONITOR OUT jack.
Select desired channel with the 3
4.
buttons.
Using the 1
5.
volume level of each channel.
Move the cursor to “RETURN” with the 3, 4, 1, and
2 cursor buttons, and press the OK/ENTER button to
go to the 1.INPUT SETUP menu.
Note:
• The volume level can be set between -12 dB and
+12 dB in 1 dB increments on all channels except the
subwoofer (SUB W), which can be set from -18dB
to +12 dB in 1 dB increments.
or
2 cursor buttons, select the
2 cursor buttons as follows;
“
V-OFF
” is selected,
or
no signal is emitted from
2 cursor buttons, adjust the
or
or
4 cursor
or
4 cursor
4 cursor
ENGLISH
43
ENGLISH
1-3 FUNCTION RENAME
Input sources can be registered under any name.
This menu is for renaming input source.
This menu is for renaming function name. Names
can be up to 10 characters long, including spaces.
(Characters are selected from those appearing on
the display.) This name appears on the unit's FL
display and the OSD, but it does not appear in the
OSD Setup menu.
Select “FUNCTION RENAME” from the 1.
1.
INPUT SETUP menu with the 3
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button.
FUNCTION RENAME
FUNCTION: TV
RENAME : TV________
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUV
WXYZabcdefghijklmnopqr
stuvwxyz0123456789!"#$
%&’()*+,../:;<=>?
_{|}SPACE BACK DEFAULT
RETURN NEXTEXIT
__
or
4 cursor
9. Repeat steps 5-8 until the new name is input.
BACK:
Deletes the character left of the cursor in the
“RENAME” area one character at a time.
DEFAULT:
Restores the name in the “RENAME” area to the
name in the “FUNCTION” area.
SPACE:
Inserts a space at the cursor point of the “RENAME”
area.
Note:
• RENAME cannot be left blank.
Move the cursor to “RETURN” with the 3, 4, 1, and
2 cursor buttons and press the OK/ENTER button to
go to the 1. INPUT SETUP menu.
2. Select “FUNCTION” with the 3
buttons.
Select an input source with the 1
3.
buttons.
Select “RENAME” with the 3
4.
buttons.
Move the cursor to the character (1st to 10th) to
5.
change with the 1
Move the cursor to the character list with the 4
6.
cursor button. (Move the cursor to the letter “A”
to begin with.)
Select a character with the 3, 4, 1, and 2
7.
cursor buttons.
Press the OK/ENTER button to enter the
8.
selected letter.
or
2 cursor buttons.
or
or
or
4 cursor
4 cursor
2 cursor
44
2 SPKR (SPEAKER) SETUP
After you have installed the unit connected all the
components and determined the speaker layout, it
is now time to perform the settings in the Speaker
Setup menu for the optimum sound acoustics for
your environment and speaker layout.
Before you perform the following settings, it is
important that you first determine the following
characteristics:
•
AUTO SETUP:
“2-1 AUTO SETUP (MultEQ Setup)”
(see page 46)
•
MANUAL SETUP:
“2-2 MANUAL SETUP”
•
THX AUDIO SETUP:
“2-3 THX AUDIO SETUP”
Select “2.SPKR SETUP” from the MAIN MENU
1.
with 3
or
4 cursor buttons and press the OK/
ENTER button.
2.SPKR SETUP
AUTO SETUP
MANUAL SETUP
THX AUDIO SETUP
(see page 49)
(see page 50)
P. 46
☞
AUTO SETUP
AUTO SETUP: START
MAIN ROOM
SURR BACK: 2CH
RETURN EXIT
AUTO SETUP
SPEAKERS CHECK:- 1st MIC POSITION
NOW ANALYZING !!
CANCEL
EXIT
2.SPKR SETUP
AUTO SETUP
MANUAL SETUP
THX AUDIO SETUP
RETURN EXIT
AUTO SETUP
NOW ANALYZING!!
CANCEL
AUTO SETUP
______________
NOW CALCULATING!
P. 49
☞
SPEAKER SIZE
THX SPKR : NO
SUB W : YES
FRONT : SMALL
CENTER : SMALL
SURR. : SMALL
SURR.B : 2CH
SURR.B SIZE : SMALL
LPF/HPF : 80Hz
BASS MIX :
RETURN NEXTEXIT
SPEAKER DISTANCE
UNIT : ft
FRONT L : 10.0 ft
CENTER : 10.0 ft
FRONT R : 10.0 ft
SURR.R : 10.0 ft
SURR.B R : 10.0 ft
SURR.B L : 10.0 ft
SURR.L : 10.0 ft
SUB W : 10.0 ft
RETURN BACK NEXTEXIT
P. 56
☞
THX AUDIO SETUP
ADVANCED SPKR ARRAY
SURR.B SPKR
:TOGETHER
RETURN EXIT
ENGLISH
RETURN EXIT
2. Select the desired menu with the 3
or
buttons, and press the OK/ENTER button.
Note:
• After you complete this the portion of the setup,
press the 3, 4, 1, and 2 cursor button. The cursor
will move to “RETURN” and press the OK/ENTER button to go to the Sub-menu.
SPEAKER LEVEL
TEST MODE : MANUAL
FRONT L : 0.0dB
CENTER : 0.0dB
FRONT R : 0.0dB
SURR.R : 0.0dB
SURR.B R : 0.0dB
SURR.B L : 0.0dB
SURR.L : 0.0dB
SUB W : 0.0dB
RETURN BACK EXIT
45
ENGLISH
M-DAX
2-1 AUTO SETUP (MultEQ™ SETUP)
The AUTO SETUP (MultEQ™ Setup) feature of
the unit measures sound characteristics of the
speaker system and room where the unit is used and
automatically optimizes settings.
The Audyssey MultEQ™ technology adopted by
this unit provides the best listening environment for
multiple listeners.
To do this, the AUTO SETUP feature measures a
test tone emitted by each channel in a maximum of 6
listening positions, using the supplied microphone.
The measurement results are analyzed using an
original algorithm and environmental settings are
made to improve the sound characteristics of the
listening area.
To set up the speaker system (i.e., adjusting speaker
distance, etc.) without using the AUTO SETUP feature,
see “MANUAL SETUP” on page 49 of the manual.
HOW TO PERFORM AUTO SETUP
During measurement, the OSD menu displays the
condition, therefore turn power to the monitor on.
Connect the supplied microphone to the MIC
1.
jack on the unit.
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF PHONES
Set the microphone in the listening position.
2.
DISP MULTI AUTO TUNED STSPKR A B V-OFF
SLEEP
SURROUND
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
SURR DIRECT
AUTO
NIGHT
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
M-DAX
ENTER
VOLUME
DOWN
AUX 1 INPUT
Notes:
• Measurement can be done in a maximum of 6
listening positions.
For the fi rst measurement, set the microphone in the
main listening position.
• Use a stand or tripod to position the microphone at
ear height in the listening position.
• Remove any obstructions between the speakers and
microphone.
• To use the internal subwoofer of the amp, set the
volume to the middle point and set the crossover
frequency to the highest.
• During measurement, step away from the microphone
and operate the unit via the remote controller from a
position that is out of the path of the speaker sound.
• The test tone output from the speakers during
measurement is loud. Be mindful of neighbors and
watch out for small children.
Select “2. SPKR SETUP” from the MAIN
3.
MENU, select “AUTO SETUP” with the 3/4
cursor buttons, and press the OK/ENTER
button to display the start screen.
Select the number of channels for the surround
4.
back speaker you are using.
For a 5.1 channel speaker system, select
“NON” (Surround Back speaker off). (To use
speaker C or multi speaker, select “NON”. See
page 38, 55.)
Select “START” with the 3/4 cursor buttons
and press the OK/ENTER button to start
measurement.
UP
AUDIOS-VIDEODIGITAL VIDEO L R
5.
AUTO SETUP
AUTO SETUP: START
MAIN ROOM
SURR BACK: 2CH
RETURN EXIT
1 st Position Check
During the fi rst position check, the following
screen is displayed as the unit checks
background noise in the listening room,
presence of speakers, and speaker polarity
and measures the acoustical characteristics in
the fi rst position where the microphone is set
up.
AUTO SETUP
SPEAKERS CHECK:- 1st MIC POSITION
NOW ANALYZING !!
CANCEL
Note:
• The detection check measures the state of use of all
speakers whether actually used or not.
For example, if the center speaker is not used, the
test tone will require time to go from the L-channel
to the R-channel, therefore be careful not to unplug
the microphone or operate this unit during this
time.
When the 1 st Position Check ends, the
6.
following OSD appears on the display.
AUTO SETUP
SPEAKERS CHECK:OK
2nd MIC POSITION!!
START
CHECK
CALCULATE
EXIT
Here, to view the results of the detection check,
select “CHECK” with the 3/4 cursor buttons
and press the OK/ENTER button. The results
will be displayed.
SPEAKER CONFIG
CHECK !! SPEAKER
FRONT : YES
CENTER : NON
FRONT R : YES
SURR.R : YES
SURR.B R : NON
SURR.B L : NON
SURR.L : YES
SUB W : YES
RETURN EXIT
If the check results indicate an error, take suitable
action with that item and remeasure. (For error
messages, see “ERROR MESSAGES” on
page 48.)
After confirming the check results, select
“RETURN” with the 3/4 cursor buttons and
press the OK/ENTER button to return to the
OSD menu.
At this point, you can select “EXIT” to end Auto
Setup and return to “2. SPKR SETUP”.
Note:
• AUTO SETUP is not available in Pure Direct,
Source Direct, or 7.1 Channel Input modes.
Move the microphone to the second listening
7.
position, select “START” with the 3/4 cursor
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button to
measure the second point. At this point, you
can cancel second point measurement and
calculate measurement results by selecting
“CALCULATE” and pressing the OK/ENTER
button.
AUTO SETUP
SPEAKERS CHECK:OK
2nd MIC POSITION!!
START
CHECK
CALCULATE
EXIT
Repeat steps 7 until measuring 6 points
8.
between the main listening position and
surrounding positions.
When all measurements end, the following
OSD appears on the display.
AUTO SETUP
SPEAKERS CHECK:OK
CALCULATE
EXIT
Select “CALCULATE” with the 3/4 cursor
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button
to calculate measurement results. During
calculations, the following OSD appears on the
display.
AUTO SETUP
______________
NOW CALCULATING!
EXIT
Note:
• Less than 6 positions can be measured, but it is
recommended to measure in all 6 positions in order
to obtain the best results.
• The time needed to complete calculations depends
on the number of connected speakers and measured
listening positions. The more speakers and listening
EXIT
positions, the more time is needed.
46
Checking Measurement Results
9.
When calculations for the measurement results
end, a screen appears for confirming the
calculation results.
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button to
enter them.
Note:
To check equalizer (MultEQ) parameters, see page
57.
[Example]
Confi rmation screen for speaker detection
SPEAKER CONFIG
CHECK !! SPEAKER
FRONT : YES
CENTER : NON
FRONT R : YES
SURR.R : YES
SURR.B R : NON
SURR.B L : NON
SURR.L : YES
SUB W : YES
RETURN NEXT
[Example] Confi rmation screen for the distance from
speakers to the listening position
DISTANCE
UNIT : ft
FRONT L : 30.00ft
CENTER : 19.33ft
FRONT R : 29.66ft
SURR.R : 21.50ft
SURR.B R : 12.33ft
SURR.B L : 11.66ft
SURR.L : 16.33ft
SUB W : 12.50ft
RETURN NEXT
* The units can be changed by moving the cursor to
[ft] of UNIT and pressing 1 / 2 the cursor buttons.
Each time a 1 / 2 cursor button is pressed, the units
alternate between [ft] (feet) and [m] (meters).
[Example] Confi rmation screen for speaker size and
crossover frequency
SPEAKER SIZE
FRONT L : AUTO
CENTER : AUTO
FRONT R : AUTO
SURR.R : AUTO
SURR.B R : AUTO
SURR.B L : AUTO
SURR.L : AUTO
RETURN NEXT
CROSSOVER FREQ
FRONT : AUTO
CENTER : AUTO
SURR : AUTO
SURR.B : AUTO
RETURN
* AUTO is displayed to indicate that the speaker size
and crossover frequency results were automatically
measured.
Storing Measurement Results in Memory
10.
Once finished confirming the measurement
results, select “RETURN” with the 3/4 cursor
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button to
display the CHECK RESULT screen.
CHANNEL LEVEL
FRONT L : 0.0dB
CENTER : -6.5dB
FRONT R : -1.5dB
SURR.R : +1.0dB
SURR.B R : +9.5dB
SURR.B L : +12.0dB
SURR.L : -2.5dB
SUB W : -12.5dB
Pressing “EXIT” prior to pressing “STORE” erases all
measurement results and calculation results, therefore
operate the remote controller with care.
When storing operations end, the following OSD
appears on the display.
2.SPKR SETUP
AUTO SETUP
MANUAL SETUP
THX AUDIO SETUP
RETURN EXIT
Notes:
• Do not turn the power to the unit off while storing
parameters in memory. This may erase all data in the
unit’s memory and may damage the unit.
• Please set any THX Certifi ed speakers manually to
“Small” and the crossover “80 Hz” after Auto setup
operation.
ENGLISH
EXIT
Place the cursor on “STORE” and press the
OK/ENTER button to store all parameters
including the equalizer parameters in memory.
If not wanting to store the calculation results in
memory, place the cursor on “EXIT” and press
47
ENGLISH
ERROR MESSAGES
MIC SET ERROR!!
Displayed ErrorCauseHow to Remedy
• The microphone is not properly connected. • Connect the included microphone.
AUTO SETUP
AUTO SETUP: START
MAIN ROOM
SURR BACK: 2CH
MIC SET ERROR!!
RETURN EXIT
• Check the microphone connection.
NOISE ERROR!!
AUTO SETUP
SPEAKERS CHECK:
NOISE ERROR !!
RETURN EXIT
ANALYZE ERROR!!
AUTO SETUP
SPEAKERS CHECK:
ANALYZE ERROR !!
RETURN NEXT EXIT
* Under ANALYZE ERROR, select “NEXT” with the 3/4 cursor
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button. A detail screen like the
following appears on the display.
SPEAKER CONFIG
CHECK !! SPEAKER
FRONT L : YES REV
CENTER : NON
FRONT R : YES REV
SURR.R : NON ERR
SURR.B R : YES ERR
SURR.B L : YES ERR
SURR.L : NON ERR
SUB W : YES
RETURN EXIT
• There is too much noise in the listening room to measure properly.
• Volume from the speakers is low.
• The speakers required for suitable playback were not detected.
• Speaker polarity is connected backwards.
In the examples at left, the following trouble is detected.
• The polarity of the left and right channels of the front speakers is
backwards ([REV] appears on the display.)
• The surround speaker is not connected ([NON] is displayed), but
the surround back speaker is connected
(In this kind of situation, [ERR] is displayed for all surround and
surround back speakers.)
An error is indicated in addition to the above if the speakers are
connected as follows.
• When using just one surround back speaker, but it is connected to
the surround back R-channel
(To use just one surround back speaker, connect it to the L-
channel.)
• During measurement, turn off devices that make noise such as air
conditioners.
• Measure at a time when the surrounding area is quiet.
• Check the speaker that is indicated as having reversed polarity
([REV] can appear with some speakers even when properly
connected. In such case, ignore the error indication.)
• Check speaker direction and layout
48
2-2 MANUAL SETUP
1. Select “2. SPKR SETUP” from the MAIN
MENU.
Select “MANUAL SETUP” with the 3
2.
cursor buttons.
Press the OK/ENTER button to enter the
3.
selection.
or
4
<SPEAKER SIZE>
SPEAKER SIZE
THX SPKR : NO
SUB W : YES
FRONT : SMALL
CENTER : SMALL
SURR. : SMALL
SURR.B : 2CH
SURR.B SIZE : SMALL
LPF/HPF : 80Hz
BASS MIX :
RETURN NEXTEXIT
When setting the speaker size in the SPEAKER SIZE
menu, use the guidelines below.
LARGE:
The complete frequency range for the channel you
are setting will be output from the speaker.
SMALL:
Frequencies of the channel you are setting that
are lower than approx. 80 Hz will be output from
the subwoofer.
If the SUB. W is set to “NONE” and the front
speakers are set to “LARGE,” then the sound will
be output from both the left and right speakers.
Select each speaker with the 3
4.
buttons.
Set the size of each speaker with the 1
5.
cursor buttons.
After you complete this portion of the setup,
6.
move the cursor to “NEXT” with the 3, 4, 1
and 2 cursor buttons and press the OK/ENTER
button to go to the next page.
THX SPKR
If you are using a full THX speaker systems which are
approved by THX Ltd:
• The front, center and surround speaker size
should be “SMALL”.
• The subwoofer should be “YES”.
• LPF/HPF (the crossover frequency) should be
“80Hz”.
You need to set the number of surround back
speakers
be “SMALL”.
and the surround back speaker size should
or
4 cursor
or
2
SUB W
YES:
Select when a subwoofer is connected.
NO:
Select when a subwoofer is not connected.
FRONT
LARGE:
Select if the front speakers are large.
SMALL:
Select if the front speakers are small.
• If “NO” is selected for the subwoofer setting, then
this setting is fi xed at “LARGE”.
CENTER
NONE:
Select if no center speaker is connected.
LARGE:
Select if the center speaker is large.
SMALL:
Select if the center speaker is small.
SURR.
NONE:
Select if no surround left and right speakers are
connected.
LARGE:
Select if the surround left and right speakers are
large.
SMALL:
Select if the surround left and right speakers are
small.
SURR. B
NONE:
Select if no surround back left and right speakers
are connected.
2CH:
Select if the surround back left and right speakers
are connected.
1CH:
Select if one surround back speaker is connected.
In this case, the audio signal is emitted from the
SURR BACK LEFT output terminal.
Notes:
• If “NONE” is selected for the SURR. setting, then
this setting is fi xed to “NONE.”
SURR. BACK SIZE
LARGE:
Select if the surround back speakers are large.
SMALL:
Select if the surround back speakers are small.
Note:
• If “NONE” is selected for the SURR. setting, then
this setting is not available.
LPF/HPF
When you use a subwoofer, you can select the cutoff
frequency for the small speakers used. Select one of
the crossover frequency levels according to the size
of the small speakers connected.
60Hz → 80Hz → 100Hz → 120Hz → 140Hz →
160Hz → 180Hz
Note:
• If using small front speakers, set a slightly higher
frequency. If using large front speakers, set a slightly
lower frequency.
BASS MIX
• The bass mix setting is only valid when “LARGE”
is set for the front speakers and “YES” is set for the
subwoofer during stereo playback.
This setting has effect only during playback of
PCM or analog stereo sources.
• When “BOTH” is selected, the low frequencies will
be played through the main L&R speakers and the
subwoofer.
In this playback mode, the low frequency range
expands more uniformly throughout the room, but
depending on the size and shape of the room,
interference may result in a decrease of the actual
volume of the low frequency range.
• By selecting “MIX”, the low frequencies will play
through the main L&R only. This selection is
preferred by THX.
Note:
• LFE signals during playback of Dolby Digital or
DTS will be played through the subwoofer.
After you complete this portion of the setup,
7.
move the cursor to “NEXT” with the
and 2
cursor buttons and press the OK/ENTER
button to go to the next page.
3, 4, 1
<SPEAKER DISTANCE>
SPEAKER DISTANCE
UNIT : ft
FRONT L : 10.0 ft
CENTER : 10.0 ft
FRONT R : 10.0 ft
SURR.R : 10.0 ft
SURR.B R : 10.0 ft
SURR.B L : 10.0 ft
SURR.L : 10.0 ft
SUB W : 10.0 ft
RETURN BACK NEXTEXIT
Use this menu to specify the distance of each
speaker’s position from the listening position. The
delay time is automatically calculated according to
these distances.
Begin by determining the ideal or most commonly
used seating position in the room.
This is important for the timing of the acoustics to
create the proper sound space that the unit and
today’s sound systems are able to produce.
Note:
• For speakers for which you have selected “NONE”,
the speaker confi guration sub-menu will not appear
here. (There are several useful books and special
DVD and LD’s available to guide you through proper
home theater confi guration. If you are unsure, have
your Marantz dealer perform the installation for you.
They are trained professionals familiar with even
the most sophisticated custom installations.
recommends the www.cedia.org website for further
information.)
Select either m (meters) or ft (feet) for UNIT
8.
with the 1
Select each speaker with the 3
9.
buttons.
Set the distance for each speaker , press the 1
10.
or
FRONT L:
Set the distance from the front left speaker to your
normal listening position.
CENTER:
Set the distance from the center speaker to your
normal listening position.
FRONT R:
Set the distance from the front right speaker to
your normal listening position.
SURR. L:
Set the distance from the surround left speaker to
your normal listening position.
SURR. R:
Set the distance from the surround right speaker to
your normal listening position.
or
2 cursor buttons.
2 cursor buttons.
or
Marantz
4 cursor
ENGLISH
49
ENGLISH
SUB W:
Set the distance from the subwoofer to your
normal listening position.
SURR. B L:
Set the distance from the surround back left
speaker to your normal listening position.
SURR. B R:
Set the distance from the surround back right
speaker to your normal listening position.
Notes:
• Set the distance to each speaker in meters (m) or feet
(ft) as follows.
m: 0.03 - 9.15 m in 0.03 m steps
ft: 0.1 - 30.0 ft in 0.1 ft steps
(The values appearing on the FL display are
approximate.)
• For the speakers that you have selected “NONE” the
speaker size menu will not appear.
• The setting for surr.back L and surr.back R appears
if it is set, two surround back speakers in the
SPEAKER SIZE menu.
• The setting of SURR. BACK appears if it is set for
one surround back speaker in the SPEAKER SIZE
menu.
After you complete this portion of the setup,
11.
move the cursor to “NEXT” with the 3, 4, 1
and 2 cursor buttons and press the OK/ENTER
button to go to the next page.
<SPEAKER LEVEL>
SPEAKER LEVEL
TEST MODE : MANUAL
FRONT L : 0.0dB
CENTER : 0.0dB
FRONT R : 0.0dB
SURR.R : 0.0dB
SURR.B R : 0.0dB
SURR.B L : 0.0dB
SURR.L : 0.0dB
SUB W : 0.0dB
RETURN BACK EXIT
Here you can set the volume for each speaker so that
they are all heard by the listener at the same level.
We recommend holding a dB SPL (Sound Pressure
Level) meter at the listening position, at arms length,
and pointing straight up at the ceiling, adjust the level
of each speaker in turn unit it reads 75dB SPL when
the meter is set to “C” weighting and Slow responce.
Note:
• The speaker level settings are not available in 7.1
Channel Input mode, Pure Direct mode and Source
Direct mode.
50
TEST MODE:
Select “MANUAL” or “AUTO” generation of the test
tone with the 1
or
2 cursor buttons.
If you select “AUTO”, the test tone will be cycled
through in a circular pattern beginning at Left →
Center → Right → Surround Right → Surround
Back Right → Surround Back Left → Surround
Left → Subwoofer → Left, in 2 seconds increments
for each channel.
Using the 1
or
2 cursor buttons, adjust the volume
level of the noise from the speaker so that it is the
same level for all the speakers.
If you select “MANUAL”, adjust the output level of
each speaker as listed below.
Move the cursor to FRONT L by pressing the
12.
4 cursor button. This unit will emit a pink noise
from the front left speaker.
Remember the level of this noise and then
press the 4 cursor button.
(Note that this can be adjusted to any level
between -12 and +12 dB in 0.5 dB increments.)
This unit will now emit the pink noise from the
center speaker.
Using the 1 and 2 cursor buttons, adjust the
13.
volume level of the noise from the center
speaker so that it is the same level as the front
left speaker.
Press the 4 cursor button again. This unit will
14.
now emit the pink noise from the front right
speaker.
Repeat steps 13 and 14 for the front right and
15.
other speakers until all speakers are adjusted
to the same volume level.
After you complete this portion of the setup, press the
OK/ENTER button to move the cursor to “RETURN”.
Press the OK/ENTER button to go to “2. SPKR SETUP”.
Notes:
• Speakers for which you selected “NONE” in the
SPEAKER SIZE menu will not appear.
• Surr. Back L and Surr. Back R appear if it is set for
two surround back speakers in the SPEAKER SIZE
menu.
• Surr. Back appears if it is set for one surround back
speaker in the SPEAKER SIZE menu.
• To adjust the speaker levels for 7.1 channel input
sources, you will need to use the 7.1 Ch Input sub
menu. (See page 51)
• SUB W can be set from –18dB to +12dB.
2-3 THX AUDIO SETUP
You can set the advanced Speaker Array.
Select “2. SPEAKER SETUP” from the MAIN
1.
MENU.
Select “THX AUDIO SETUP” with the 3
2.
cursor buttons.
3. Press the OK/ENTER button to enter the
selection.
THX AUDIO SETUP
ADVANCED SPKR ARRAY
SURR.B SPKR
:TOGETHER
RETURN EXIT
Advanced Speaker Array (ASA)
SURR.B SPKR: TOGETHER, CLOSE or APART
The best ASA effect is when the surround back
speakers are together and facing forward.
If the distance between the surround back speakers
is,
• Less than 12 in. (30 cm): TOGETHER
• Greater than 12 in. (30 cm), and less than 48 in.
(122 cm): CLOSE
• Greater than 48 in. (122 cm): APART
Speaker type and positioning
This diagram shows the desired positioning for 7.1
channel speaker systems used in ASA mode. During
system setup, select the distance between surround
back speakers.
FL
Front-LCenterFront-R
Surround-LSurround-R
SL
Surround A
Surround Back
C
LR
SBL SBR
Surround B
Surround A
FR
Di-polar Radiating Speaker
Direct Radiating Speaker
SR
or
4
Note:
• If you set SURR.B = 1CH or NONE in the
SPEAKER SIZE menu, Advanced Speaker Array
will not be activated.
After you complete this portion of the setup, move
the cursor to “RETURN” with 3, 4, 1 and 2 cursor
buttons and press OK/ENTER button to go to the 2.
SPKR SETUP menu.
3 SURROUND SETUP
This menu is for setting surround effect parameters
for the various surround input signals so as to bring
out the live audio effect of your speaker system.
•
CHANNEL LEVEL:
“3-1 CHANNEL LEVEL”
•
PL
II
x MUSIC PARAMETER:
“3-2 PLII x MUSIC PARAMETER”
•
CSII PARAMETER:
“3-3 CSII PARAMETER”
•
NEO:6 PARAMETER:
“3-4 NEO:6 PARAMETER”
1. Select “3. SURR SETUP” from the MAIN
MENU with the 3
the OK/ENTER button.
Select the desired menu with the 3
2.
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button.
3.SURR SETUP
CHANNEL LEVEL
PL x MUSIC PARAMETER
CS PARAMETER
NEO:6 PARAMETER
RE-EQ : OFF
LFE LEVEL :
M-DAX : OFF
RETURN NEXTEXIT
RE-EQ:
Turns THX Cinema Re-EQ™ on and off.
Select the Cinema Re-EQ™ with the 1 or 2 cursor
button to activate it.
LFE LEVEL:
Select the output level of the LFE signal included in
the Dolby Digital signal or the DTS signal.
Select “0dB”, “–10 dB” or “OFF” with 1 or 2 cursor
button.
M-DAX:
Select the desired M-DAX mode.
Select “HIGH”, “LOW” or “OFF” with the 1 or 2
cursor button. (See page 59)
After you complete this portion of the setup, move
the cursor to “RETURN” with the 3, 4, 1, 2 cursor
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button.
(see page 51)
(see page 52)
(see page 52)
(see page 52)
or
4 cursor buttons and press
or
4 cursor
3.SURR SETUP
CHANNEL LEVEL
PL x MUSIC PARAMETER
CS PARAMETER
NEO:6 PARAMETER
RE-EQ : OFF
LFE LEVEL :
M-DAX : OFF
RETURN NEXTEXIT
P. 51
☞
CHANNEL LEVEL
SURR.MODE:
AUTO
CENTER : 0.0dB
SURR.R : 0.0dB
SURR.B R : 0.0dB
SURR.B L : 0.0dB
SURR.L : 0.0dB
SUB W : 0.0dB
RETURN EXIT
P. 52
☞
PL x MUSIC PARAMETER
PARAMETER :DEFAULT
PANORAMA :OFF
DIMENSION : 0
CENTER WIDTH: 3
RETURN NEXTEXIT
P. 52
☞
CS PARAMETER
TRUBASS : 0
SRS DIALOG : 0
RETURN NEXTEXIT
P. 52
☞
NEO:6 PARAMETER
CENTER GAIN : 0.3
RETURN NEXTEXIT
3-1 CHANNEL LEVEL
1. Select “3. SURR SETUP” from MAIN MENU
with 3
or
4 cursor buttons and press the OK/
ENTER button.
Select “CHANNEL LEVEL” with the 3
2.
cursor buttons and press the OK/ENTER
button.
Set the SURR. MODE with the 1
3.
buttons.
CHANNEL LEVEL
SURR.MODE:
AUTO
CENTER : 0.0dB
SURR.L : 0.0dB
SURR.R : 0.0dB
SURR.BACK L : 0.0dB
SURR.BACK R : 0.0dB
SUB W : 0.0dB
RETURN EXIT
4. Select the desired menu item with the 3
cursor buttons, set the desired level with the 1
or
2 cursor buttons, and press the OK/ENTER
button.
SURROUND MODE:
The surround mode can be independently set for
3 modes.
1. Multi Ch STEREO
2. CSII
3. Others
CHANNEL LEVEL
CENTER LEVEL:
Set the effect level of the center speaker between
–12 and +12 level in 0.5 level interval .
• If “NONE” was selected for the center speaker
setting in the SPEAKER SIZE, then this setting will
not appear.
SURR L or R LEVEL:
Set the effect level of the Surround speaker
between –12 and +12 level in 0.5 level interval .
• If “NONE” was selected for the surround speakers
setting in the SPEAKER SIZE, then this setting will
not appear.
SURR. BACK L or R LEVEL:
Set the effect level of the Surround Back speaker
between –12 and +12 level in 0.5 level interval .
• If “NONE” was selected for the surround back
speakers setting in the SPEAKER SIZE, then this
setting will not appear.
or
or
4
2 cursor
or
4
ENGLISH
51
ENGLISH
SUB W LEVEL:
Set the effect level of the subwoofer speaker
between –18 and +12 level in 0.5 level interval .
• If “NONE” was selected for the subwoofer speaker
setting in the SPEAKER SIZE, then this setting will
not appear.
Note:
• Setting to a mode other than multichannel stereo or
CSII will affect the speaker level as explained in “2-2
MANUAL SETUP”.
After you complete this portion of the setup, move the
cursor to “RETURN” with the 3, 4, 1 and 2 cursor
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button to go to the
3. SURR SETUP menu.
3-2 PLIIx (PRO LOGIC IIx) MUSIC PARAMETER
Pro LogicIIx-Music mode creates a rich and
enveloping surround ambience from stereo sources
such as CDs.
In this mode, this unit includes three controls to fi netune the sound fi eld as follows.
Select “3. SURR SETUP” in MAIN MENU
1.
with 3
or
4 cursor buttons and press the OK/
ENTER button.
Select “PLIIx MUSIC PARAMETER” with the 3
2.
or
4 cursor buttons.
Press the OK/ENTER button to enter the
3.
selection.
PL x MUSIC PARAMETER
PARAMETER :DEFAULT
PANORAMA :OFF
DIMENSION : 0
CENTER WIDTH: 3
setting in the SPEAKER SIZE menu, this setting
cannot be selected.
After you complete this portion of the setup, move
cursor to “RETURN” with the 3, 4, 1 and 2 cursor
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button.
3-3 CSII PARAMETER
1. Select “3. SURROUND SETUP” from MAIN
MENU with the 3
the OK/ENTER button.
Select “CS II PARAMETER” with the 3
2.
cursor buttons.
Press the OK/ENTER button to enter the
3.
selection.
CS PARAMETER
TRUBASS : 0
SRS DIALOG : 0
or
4 cursor buttons and press
or
3-4 NEO:6 PARAMETER
The DTS NEO:6 mode enables a maximum 6.1
channel output with just 2 channel input. (It also
supports 5.1 channel input.)
This mode expands the sound image from the center
channel.
Select “3. SURROUND SETUP” from MAIN
1.
4
MENU with the 3
the OK/ENTER button.
Select “NEO:6 PARAMETER” with the 3
2.
cursor buttons.
Press the OK/ENTER button to enter the
3.
selection.
NEO:6 PARAMETER
CENTER GAIN : 0.3
or
4 cursor buttons and press
or
4
RETURN NEXTEXIT
PARAMETER:
Select “DEFAULT” or “CUSTOM” with the 1 or 2
cursor buttons.
If you select “CUSTOM”, you can adjust three
parameters as listed below.
PANORAMA:
Select the PANORAMA mode “ON” or “OFF” with
the 1 or 2 cursor buttons.
Panorama wraps the sound of the front left and right
speakers around you, for an exciting perspective.
DIMENSION:
Set the DIMENSION level between –3 and +3 level
in 1 level intervals with the 1 or 2 cursor buttons.
Adjust the sound fi eld either towards the front or
towards the rear.
This can be useful to help achieve a more
suitable balance from all the speakers with certain
recordings.
CENTER WIDTH:
Set the CENTER WIDTH level between 0 and 7 in
1 level intervals with the 1 or 2 cursor buttons.
Center width allows you to gradually spread the
center channel sound into the front left and right
speakers.
At its widest setting, all the sound from the center
is mixed into the left and right speakers.
This control may help achieve a more spacious
sound or a better blend for the front image.
If “NONE” was selected for the center speaker
RETURN NEXTEXIT
TRUBASS:
Set the TRUBASS level between 0 and 6 in 1- level
increments with the
TRUBASS produced by the speakers are an octave
below the actual physical capabilities of the speakers
adding exciting, deeper bass effects.
SRS DIALOG:
Set the SRS DIALOG level between
increments
This can be popped out of the surround audio
effects, allowing the listener to easily discern what
the actors say.
If “NONE” was selected for the center speaker
setting in the SPEAKER SIZE menu, this setting
cannot be selected.
After you complete this portion of the setup, move
cursor to “RETURN” with the 3, 4, 1 and 2 cursor
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button.
Note:
• This parameter can only be set in the CSII mode.
1 or 2
cursor buttons.
with the 1 or 2 cursor buttons.
0 and 6
in 1-
RETURN NEXTEXIT
4. Set the CENTER GAIN level between 0.0 and
1.0 in 0.1 level
buttons.
After you complete this portion of the setup, move
cursor to “RETURN” with the 3, 4, 1 and 2 cursor
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button.
Notes:
• This parameter can only be set in the NEO:6-Music
mode.
• If “NONE” was selected for the center speaker
setting in the SPEAKER SIZE menu, this setting is
disabled.
increments
with the 1
or
2 cursor
52
4 VIDEO SETUP
Video settings are made as follows.
Select “4. VIDEO SETUP” from the MAIN
1.
MENU with the 3/4 cursor buttons and press
the OK/ENTER button.
4.VIDEO SETUP
VIDEO CONVERT
TV.AUTO :DISABLE
OSD INFO :ENABLE
I/P CONVERT :ENABLE
HDMI OUT :OUTPUT1
COMPO OUT2 :MAIN
RETURN NEXTEXIT
Select the desired menu with the 3/4 cursor
2.
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button.
•
VIDEO CONVERT
“4-1 VIDEO CONVERT”
•
TV-AUTO
Select the TV AUTO ON/OFF function to enable
or disable with the 1 or 2 cursor buttons. (refer to
page 66)
•
OSD INFO
Select the OSD information function to “ENABLE”
or “DISABLE” with the 1 or 2 cursor buttons.
If you select “ENABLE”, this unit will display the
status of the feature (Volume up/down, input
select, etc..) on the monitor. If you do not desire
this information, select “DISABLE”.
Note:
• OSD information is not output to Monitor Output
of HDMI and Component Video. However, OSD
information is output if the Video Convert function
is used to output Video or S-Video video signals to
Monitor Out of HDMI and Component Video.
For details, refer to“VIDEO CONVERT”on page 59.
•
IP CONVERT
Select the IP CONVERT ON/OFF function to
enable or disable with the 1 or 2 cursor buttons.
(refer to page 59)
•
HDMI OUT
This setting is for selecting which output terminal,
HDMI 1 or HDMI 2, to output the signal to. Select
the output destination with the 1 / 2 cursor
buttons.
To use the remote controller (RC8001SR) to
change the HDMI OUT setting, press the AMP
button and then the > button until the second page
is displayed. After HDMI 1 or HDMI 2 is displayed
on the remote controller, press the D3 or D4 button
to switch between them.
M
D1
D2
D3
D3
D4
D4
PAGE
2
D5
D5
CD
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
AMP
LIGHT
RC8001SR
TUNER
TAPE
•
COMPONENT OUT 2
USE
AUX1
12
Learning Remote Controller
(This feature is not available on the SR7002.)
This setting is for selecting whether to output
the images for the main room or the images for
the multi room system to the COMPONENT
MONITOR OUT 2 terminal. Select the output
destination between MAIN and MULTI with the 1 /
2 cursor buttons.
Note:
• When MULTI is selected, video signals converted
from the MONITOR OUT 2 terminal are not
output.
After you complete this portion of the setup, move
cursor to “RETURN” with the 3, 4, 1 and 2 cursor
ENTER
buttons and press the OK/
button.
4-1 VIDEO CONVERT
This unit is equipped to convert video signals for
monitor output.
This section explains how to set up conversion for
each type of video input.
Select “4. VIDEO SETUP” from the MAIN
1.
MENU with the 3 / 4 cursor buttons and press
the OK/ENTER button.
buttons and set the video conversion mode
with the 1 / 2 cursor buttons
ANA&HDMI:
This mode both up-converts and down-converts
analog video signals (Composite Video, S-Video,
Component Video). Furthermore, it up-converts
from analog video signal to HDMI. (It cannot downconvert from HDMI digital video signals to analog
video signals.)
ANA ONLY:
This mode both up-converts and down-converts
analog video signals (Composite Video, S-Video,
Component Video). It does not up-convert to
HDMI.
OFF:
This mode turns off all conversion features.
Note:
• For details on video convert feature, see page 59.
ENGLISH
53
ENGLISH
5 PREFERENCE
•
MULTI ROOM SETUP :
“5-1 MULTI ROOM SETUP”
•
DC TRIGGER SETUP :
“5-2 DC TRIGGER SETUP”
Select “5. PREFERENCE” from MAIN MENU
1.
with the 3
or
4 cursor buttons and press the
(see page 55)
(see page 55)
OK/ENTER button.
5.PREFERENCE
MULTI ROOM SETUP A B
DC TRIGGER SETUP 1 2
STANDBY : NORMAL
BILINGUAL : MAIN
HDMI AUDIO: ENABLE
HDMI LIP : ENABLE
RETURN NEXTEXIT
2. Select the desired menu with the 3
buttons and press the OK/ENTER button.
STAND BY:
When this is set to “ECONOMY”, you can reduce
the power consumption when the unit is in the
Standby mode. When “ECONOMY” is selected,
“TV AUTO” and “RS-232C” are disabled when the
unit is in the Standby mode.
BILINGUAL:
In the Bilingual mode, Dolby Digital and DTS
output is set to either “MAIN” or “SUB”. Select
“BILINGUAL” with the 1 or 2 cursor buttons, then
select MAIN ↔ SUB ↔ MAIN+SUB with the 1 or
2 cursor buttons.
HDMI AUDIO:
This setting determines whether to play back audio
input to the HDMI jacks through the unit or output it
through the unit to a TV or projector.
ENABLE: The audio input to the HDMI jacks
can be played back by this unit.
In such case, audio signals are not
output to the TV or projector.
THROUGH: The audio input to the HDMI jacks is
not output from the speaker terminals
of the unit. Audio data is output
directly to the TV or projector. This
setting is used to listen to audio on a
multi channel TV, etc.
or
4 cursor
HDMI LIP (Auto Lipsync Correction):
Video signals may take longer to process than
audio signals depending on the connected video
equipment.
When the unit is connected to TV or Projector
supporting Auto Lipsync Correction in HDMI
1.3a, audio and video can be automatically
synchronized using this function.
Use the 1 or 2 cursor buttons to switch between
ENABLE and DISABLE.
ENABLE: Auto Lipsync Correction is used to
synchronize audio and video.
DIESABLE: Deactivates this function.
Note:
• This function is not available when the unit is
connected to equipment that does not support HDMI
1.3a or Auto Lipsync Correction. For details, check
the user’s manual of the connected equipment.
• If this function is unavailable, you can use the
regular lipsync function to synchronize audio and
video. (See page 66)
5.PREFERENCE
MULTI ROOM SETUP A B
DC TRIGGER SETUP 1 2
STANDBY : NORMAL
BILINGUAL : MAIN
HDMI AUDIO: ENABLE
HDMI LIP : ENABLE
RETURN NEXTEXIT
DC TRIGGER SETUP
DC TRIG-1:DISABLE
TV : TAPE :
DVD : CD/R :
VCR1 : AUX2 :
DSS : TUNER :
AUX1 : 7.1CH :
RETURN BACK EXIT
DC TRIGGER SETUP
DC TRIG-2:DISABLE
TV : TAPE :
DVD : CD/R :
VCR1 : AUX2 :
DSS : TUNER :
AUX1 : 7.1CH :
RETURN BACK EXIT
MULTI ROOM SETUP A
VIDEO :DVD
AUDIO :DVD
SLEEP :OFF
MONO/ST:STEREO
OSD INFO:ENABLE
MULT:OFF MSPK:
VOL :VARI VOL :
LEV :-90dB LEV :
RETURN BACK EXIT
MULTI ROOM SETUP B
AUDIO :DVD
SLEEP :OFF
MONO/ST:STEREO
MULT:OFF MSPK:
VOL :VARI VOL :
LEV :-90dB LEV :
RETURN BACK EXIT
(The SR7002 is not equipped
with the MULTI ROOM SETUP
B feature)
After you complete this portion of the setup, move the
cursor to “RETURN” with the 3, 4, 1 and 2 cursor
ENTER
buttons and press the OK/
button.
54
5-1 MULTI ROOM SETUP
The SR8002 has source selectors, sleep timers and
multispeaker output remote controller for the two
other rooms in the multi room system. (The SR7002
has only one other room in the multi-room system.)
These features can be set from this menu.
Select “5. PREFERENCE” from the MAIN
1.
MENU with the 3 or 4 cursor buttons and
press the OK/ENTER button.
Select “MULTI ROOM SETUP” with the 3 or 4
2.
cursor buttons and select either “Room A” or
“Room B” with the 1 or 2 cursor buttons.
Press the OK/ENTER button to enter the
3.
setting.
The following explanation shows how to operate
MULTI ROOM A of the multi-room system.
The MULTI ROOM B setting does not have the
VIDEO FUNCTION.
(The SR7002 does not have a MULTI ROOM B
setting)
MULTI ROOM SETUP A
VIDEO :DVD
AUDIO :DVD
SLEEP :OFF
MONO/ST:STEREO
OSD INFO:ENABLE
MULT:OFF MSPK:
VOL :VARI VOL :
LEV :-90dB LEV :
RETURN BACK EXIT
Select the desired item with the 3
4.
button.
VIDEO:
Select the video source of the multiroom output
with the 1 or 2 cursor buttons.
AUDIO:
Select the audio source of the multiroom output
with the 1 or 2 cursor buttons.
SLEEP:
The sleep mode is available when the multiroom is
active, set the time with 1 or 2 cursor buttons. The
sleep timer can be set to a maximum 90 minutes
in 10 minute increments.
MONO/ST:
This mode switches audio output to the multi room
system between MONAURAL and STEREO,
using the 1 and 2 cursor buttons.
or
4 cursor
OSD INFO:
With this function, on-screen display information is
shown on connected TVs or other devices when
you switch input functions. Select “ENABLE” with
the 1 or 2 cursor buttons to enable OSD INFO or
“DISABLE” to disable it. Select “DISABLE” if this
function is not needed.
MULTI (MULTI ROOM):
Switch the multiroom output “ON” or “OFF” with the
1 or 2 cursor buttons.
MSPK (MULTI SPEAKER):
Switch the speaker output “ON” or “OFF” with the
1 or 2 cursor buttons.
VOL (VOLUME SETUP):
Select whether the multiroom or multi speaker
output level is variable or fi xed with the 1 or 2
cursor buttons.
LEVEL (VOLUME LEVEL):
Adjust the multiroom output level with the 1 or 2
cursor buttons. The volume can be set between
-90 dB and 0 dB in 1 dB increments.
Note:
• This setting can be changed when the SURR B is
set to “NONE” in the SPEAKER SIZE menu and
“SPEAKER C” is in the OFF position on the rear
panel. When this setting is unavailable, “***” is
displayed.
• If “VOLUME” is set to “FIXED”, the multiroom
output level cannot be adjusted from the A or B
room.
• MSPK cannot be on for both Room A and Room B at
the same time. After you complete this portion of the
setup, move the cursor to “RETURN” with the 3 or
4 cursor buttons and press the OK/ENTER button.
5-2 DC TRIGGER SETUP
This unit has 2 DC trigger control jacks, which can
be used to link with input functions for the main room
or multiroom.
Each trigger can be setup separately.
Select “5. PREFERENCE” from MAIN MENU
1.
with the 3OK/ENTER button.
Select “DC TRIGGER SETUP 1or 2” with the
2.
3, 4, 1 and 2 cursor buttons.
Press the OK/ENTER button to enter the
3.
selection.
4. You can select “MAIN ROOM”, “MULTI ROOM A”, “MULTI ROOM B”, “REMOTE”
“DISABLE” with the 1
(The SR7002 does not have a MULTI ROOM B
setting)
Note:
• REMOTE is available for the external control. The
RC8001SR cannot operate the function.
Select desired input source with the 3
5.
cursor buttons.
Set to “ON” or “OFF” with the 1
6.
buttons.
After you complete this portion of the setup,
7.
move the cursor to “RETURN” with the 3
4 cursor button and press the OK/ENTER
button.
Note:
• When an input source that is on in the set room is
selected, voltage is output to the DC TRIGGER
output terminal.
or
4 cursor buttons and press the
DC TRIGGER SETUP
DC TRIG-1:DISABLE
TV : TAPE :
DVD : CD/R :
VCR1 : AUX2 :
DSS : TUNER :
AUX1 : 7.1CH :
RETURN NEXTEXIT
or
2 cursor buttons.
or
or
or
4
2 cursor
or
ENGLISH
55
ENGLISH
6 ACOUSTIC EQ
This display is for setting up the equalizer and
changing the Equalizer mode.
•
PRESET G. EQ ADJ :
“6-1 PRESET G. EQ ADJ”
•
CHECK AUTO 1 & 2 :
“6-2 CHECK AUTO”
(see page 57)
(see page 57)
EQ MODE:
There are 4 equalizer modes to choose from:
PRESET G. EQ that allows the user to manually
adjust the equalizer, and AUDYSSEY, FRONT and
FLAT that automatically adjust the equalizer from the
measurement results of the AUTO SETUP feature
(see page 46).
AUDYSSEY:
This mode adjusts the frequency characteristics
of all speakers so as to create the best listening
environment for the sound characteristics of the
listening room.
FRONT:
This mode matches the characteristics of each
speaker to those of the front speakers.
FLAT:
This mode fl attens the frequency characteristics of
all speakers. It is suited for playback of multichannel
music such as Dolby Digital and DTS.
PRESET:
This mode adjusts the graphic equalizer that
was set in PRESET G.EQ ADJ to adjust the
characteristics of each speaker (see page 57).
OFF:
The graphic equalizer is not used.
1. Select “6. ACOUSTIC EQ” from MAIN MENU
with the 3
or
4 cursor buttons and press the
OK/ENTER button.
6.ACOUSTIC EQ.
EQ.MODE : OFF
PRESET G.EQ ADJ
CHECK AUTO
Select “FRONT”, “FLAT”, “AUDYSSEY”,
3.
“PRESET” or “OFF” with the 1
or
2 cursor
buttons.
After you complete this portion of the setup, move the
cursor to “RETURN” with the 3, 4, 1 and 2 cursor
ENTER
buttons and press the OK/
button.
To use the remote controller (RC8001SR) to change
the EQ MODE, press the AMP button and then the
> button until the second page is displayed. When
EQ is displayed on the remote controller, press the
EQ (D5) button.
M
D1
D2
D3
USE
TUNERCDCD-R
TAPE
12
Learning Remote Controller
D4
PAGE
2
D5
D5
D5
MD
AMP
AUX2
AUX1
AMP
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Each time this button is pressed, the EQ MODE
changes as follows.
OFFAUDYSSEYFRONTFLATPRESET
Notes:
• “FRONT”, “FLAT” and “AUDYSSEY” can be
selected after executing the AUTO SETUP feature.
• If a speaker that was determined “NON” in Auto
Setup is manually turned on, the “AUDYSSEY”,
“FRONT” and “FLAT” modes cannot be selected.
• The equalizer turns off when the Pure Direct mode,
Source Direct mode, Dolby Headphone or Virtual
mode is set.
• ACOUSTIC EQ MODEs are not used during
playback of Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus, or
DTS-HD signals.
• Tone Control is disabled when an EQ MODE is in
use.
CHECK AUTO
MD:AUDYSSEY 63-15.0
CH:SR 125 -2.0
250 -5.0
+9
500 +9.0
0dB
1k +3.0
2k -5.0
4k -7.0
-20-20
8k-18.0
63
250 1k 4k 16k
16k-20.0
125 500 2k 8k
RETURN EXIT
RETURN NEXTEXIT
2. Select “EQ. MODE” with the 3
buttons.
56
or
4 cursor
6-1 PRESET G. EQ ADJ
These modes allow you to set a 9-band graphic
equalizer for each of the 7 channels.
Select “6. ACOUSTIC EQ” from MAIN MENU
1.
with the 3OK/ENTER button.
Select “PRESET G. EQ ADJ” with the 3
2.
cursor buttons.
Press the OK/ENTER button to enter the
3.
selection.
RESET:
Using the 1 or 2 cursor buttons, select the
channel(s) to be reset to either the currently
displayed channel (“CH”) or all channels (“ALL”),
and press the OK/ENTER button to enter the
setting.
“ALL” : Resets all channels.
“CH” : Resets only the currently displayed
CH:
Select the channel (“FL”, “C”, “FR”, “SR”, “SBR”,
“SBL” or “SL”) to adjust with the 1 or 2 cursor
buttons, and switch to the adjustment mode with
the 4 cursor button.
Frequency:
Select the target frequency on the graph with the
1 or 2 cursor buttons and press the OK/ENTER
button to enter the selection. Adjust the level with
the 3 or 4 cursor buttons. (Note that this can be
adjusted to any level between –20 and +9 dB in 0.5
dB increments.)
Move to the next frequency with the 1 or 2 cursor
buttons, and adjust the level.
These menus are for confirming the results of
AUTO SETUP function equalizer measurement
(AUDYSSEY, FRONT, FLAT).
Select “6. ACOUSTIC EQ” from MAIN MENU
1.
with the 3OK/ENTER button.
2. Select “CHECK AUTO” with the3 or 4 cursor
buttons.
Press the OK/ENTER button to enter the
3.
selection.
Select MD (mode) with the 3 / 4 cursor buttons
followed by the desired equalizer (“AUDYSSEY”,
“FRONT”, “FLAT”).
CH:
Select the channel to check with the 1 or 2 cursor
buttons.
Notes:
• The frequency will not be exactly the same as in the
Preset G. EQ modes.
• FL and FR are not indicated on the CHECK AUTO
2 menu.
Once fi nished checking, select “RETURN” with
4.
the 3 / 4 cursor buttons and press the OK/
ENTER button to return to the “6. ACOUSTIC
EQ” menu.
or
4 cursor buttons and press the
CHECK AUTO
MD:AUDYSSEY 63 0.0
CH:FL 125 0.0
250 0.0
+9
500 0.0
0dB
1k 0.0
2k 0.0
-20
4k 0.0
8k 0.0
63
250 1k 4k 16k
16k 0.0
125 500 2k 8k
RETURN EXIT
ENGLISH
After you complete this portion of the setup, press the
OK/ENTER button to enter the settings. Move cursor
to “RETURN” with the 3, 4, 1 and 2 cursor buttons
and press the OK/ENTER button.
57
ENGLISH
G
E
K
L
7.1CH
ATT
SPK-AB
A
L
D
58
BASIC OPERATION
(PLAY BACK)
SELECTING AN INPUT SOURCE
Before you can listen to any input media, you must
fi rst select the input source on the unit.
Example : DVD
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
To select DVD, turn the INPUT SELECTOR knob
on the front panel or press the DVD button on the
remote controller two times in a row. After you have
selected DVD, simply turn on the DVD player and
play the DVD.
• As the input source is changed, the new input
name will appear momentarily an OSD information
on the video display. The input name will also
appear in the display, on the front-panel.
• If you use the FUNCTION RENAME feature (see
page 44) , the renamed name appears on the
display.
• As the input is changed, this unit will automatically
switch to the digital input, surround mode,
attenuation, and night mode status which were
entered during the confi guration process for that
source.
• When a video source is selected, the selected
video signal is output from the MONITOR OUT
terminal.
PURE DIRECT
DISP MULTI AUTO TUNE
SURR DIRECT
AUTO
SLEEP
DSD
MU
SURROUND
SPE
MODE AUTO
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
MENU
TV
TUNER
TAPE
12
DVD
CD
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
DSS
VCRDVD
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
SELECTING THE SURROUND MODE
Example: AUTO SURROUND
LEARN
NAME
USE
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
(Using the unit)
To select the Auto surround mode during playback,
press the AUTO button on the front panel.
(Using the remote controller)
To select the Auto surround mode, press the
AMP button and press the > button until PAGE1 is
displayed. Press the AUTO (D1) button.
• For surround modes, see “Surround Mode” on
page 60.
• To add the THX mode to the Auto Surround mode,
press either the THX button on the unit or the THX
button on the remote controller.
• To select a specifi c surround mode, Press the
individual surround mode button on page 1.2 on
the remote controller.
PURE DIRECT
DISP MULTI AUTO TUNED
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
AUTO
DSD
MU
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
SPEA
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
MENU
DISP
CLEAR
TUNER
TAPE
12
Learning Remote Controller
M
D1
D2
D3
D4
PAGE
123
4
D5
D5
564
OSD
SLEEP
97
8
MEMO
0
CD
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
AUX1
AMP
LIGHT
RC8001SR
DIALOGUE NORMALIZATION MESSAGE
Dialogue Normalization (Dial Norm) is a feature of
Dolby Digital.
When playing back software which has been encoded
in Dolby Digital, sometimes you may see a brief
message on the FL display which will read "D-NORM
X dB" (X being a numeric value).
Dialogue Normalization serves to let you know if the
source material has been recorded at a higher or
lower level than usual. For example, if you see the
following message: "D-NORM + 4 dB" on the FL
display, to keep the overall output level constant just
turn down the volume control by 4 dB. In other words,
the source material that you are listening to has been
recorded 4 dB louder than usual.
If you do not see a message on the FL display, then
no adjustment of the volume control is necessary.
NIGHT MODE
Useful at night or when loud noise is undesirable,
this mode compresses the dynamic range, making
it easier to hear quieter audio content without
increasing the overall volume.
Note that the effect of night mode is determined
by the Dolby Digital content. Night mode may have
no effect with content that does not support this
function.
M
D1
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
TUNER
AUX1
TAPE
12
Learning Remote Controller
To select this mode, press the AMP button on
1.
the remote controller, and then press the >
button until PAGE3 is displayed.
Each time the NIGHT (D1) button is pressed,
2.
the mode changes according to the following
options indicated on the front of the unit.
• AUTO Mode
NIGHT AUTO
AUTO mode is available when decording Dolby
TrueHD signals.
When night mode is activated, “NIGHT” is
illuminated on the front of the unit. (See page 9)
•
NIGHTModeON
NIGHT ON
Setting the Night mode to “ON” compresses the
dynamic range in Dolby Digital only.
• NIGHT Mode OFF
NIGHT OFF
Turn off the Night mode.
D2
D3
D4
PAGE
123
4
D5
D5
CD
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
AMP
LIGHT
RC8001SR
↓
↓
ADJUSTING THE MAIN VOLUME
AK ANALOG
HT
BAND
SURROUND
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
EQ
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX A/B
EXIT
MIC
VOLUME
DOWN
DIGITAL
UP
AUX 1 INPUT
RLVIDEO
S-VIDEO
AUDIO
CH
PREV
MENU
TEST
7.1CH
Adjust the volume to a comfortable level using
the VOLUME control knob on the front panel or
VOLUME3 / 4 buttons on the remote controller.
To increase the volume, turn the VOLUME knob
clockwise or press VOLUME 3 button on the remote,
to decrease the volume, turn counterclockwise or
press VOLUME4 button on the remote controller.
Notes:
• The volume can be adjusted within the range of – ∞
to 18 dB, in steps of 1 dB.
•
However, when the channel level is set as described on
page 51, if the volume for any channel is set at +1 dB
or greater, the volume cannot be adjusted up to 18 dB.
(In this case the maximum volume adjustment range
is “18 dB - Maximum value of channel level)
VOL
VOL
OK
LIP.SYNC
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
231
ATT
SPK-AB
H
ADJUSTING THE TONE (BASS & TREBLE)
LIP.SYNC
CONTROL
M
D1
D2
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
TUNER
TAPE
12
Learning Remote Controller
D2
D3
D3
D4
D4
PAGE
123
4
D5
D5
D5
CD
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
AUX1
AMP
LIGHT
RC8001SR
During a listening session you may wish to adjust the
Bass and Treble Control to suit your listening tastes
or room acoustics.
(Using the remote controller)
adjust the tone
To
, press the AMP button and press
the > button PAGE3 is displayed.
To adjust the bass effect, press BASS+ (D2) or BASS– (D3).
To adjust the treble effect, TREB+ (D4) or TREB–(D5).
Notes:
• The tone control function is unavailable for the
Source Direct, Pure Direct, Headphone, Dolby
Virtual Speaker, THX mode, and 176.4/192kHz
PCM.
• The tone control function is not available when
ACOUSTIC EQ is being used.
• Additionally, tone control is not available during
Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus, or DTS-HD
playback.
TEMPORARILY TURNING OFF THE SOUND
OK
LIP.SYNC
PREV
MENU
TEST
7.1CH
DISP
To temporarily silence all speaker outputs such as
when interrupted by a phone call, press the MUTE
button on the remote controller.
This will interrupt the output to all speakers and the
head-phone jack, but it will not affect any recording or
dubbing that may be in progress.
When the system is muted, the display will show
“MUTE” .
Press the MUTE button again to return to normal
operation.
MUTE
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
231
ATT
SPK-AB
564
OSD
SLEEP
USING THE SLEEP TIMER
PREV
MENU
TEST
7.1CH
DISP
CLEAR
To program this unit for automatic standby, press the
SLEEP button on the remote controller.
Each press of the button will increase the time before
shut down in the following sequence.
OFF1020305040
10090807060110120
The sleep time will be shown for a few seconds in the
display on the front panel, and it will count down until
the time has elapsed.
When the programmed sleep time has elapsed, the
unit will automatically turn off.
Note that the SLEEP indicator on the display will
illuminate when the Sleep function is programmed.
To cancel the Sleep function, press the SLEEP
button until the display shows “SLEEP OFF” and the
SLEEP indicator will disappear.
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
231
ATT
SPK-AB
564
OSD
SLEEP9SLEEP
8097
THX
MEMO
M-DAX (Marantz Dynamic Audio eXpander)
M
D1
D2
D2
D3
D3
D4
USE
TUNER
AUX1
TAPE
12
Learning Remote Controller
This function makes up for lost audio content in MP3
or AAC sources (from lossy compression) during
playback. Choose one of the following levels for this
effect as desired.
“HIGH”: Stronger effect
“LOW”: Weaker effect
“OFF”: Deactivated.
D4
PAGE
4
D5
D5
D5
CD
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
AMP
LIGHT
RC8001SR
(Using the remote controller)
When switching to M-DAX mode, press the AMP
button and then the > button until the PAGE 4 is
displayed.
When “M-DAX” is displayed on the remote controller,
press the M-DAX (D5) button.
Each time this button is pressed, M-DAX changes
as follows.
OFFLOWHIG
Notes:
• M-DAX is compatible with PCM (48 kHz or lower)
and two-channel analog sources.
• The M-DAX is not available when Dolby Virtual
Speaker mode is being used.
VIDEO CONVERT
ANALOG VIDEO CONVERSION
This unit is equipped to convert video signals
for monitor output. Because of this, indifferent of
the connection (VIDEO, S-VIDEO, COMPONENT
VIDEO) between the playback device and this unit,
listening and viewing are possible with a single
higher grade cable between the MONITOR OUT
terminal of the unit and the monitor.
UP-CONVERSION FROM ANALOG VIDEO
SIGNALS TO HDMI
The up-conversion feature of this unit can output
the input analog video signals (for component video
signals of 480i, 480p, 1080i and 720p resolution, and
S-Video and Video (composite) of 480i resolution) to
the HDMI MONITOR terminal.
Notes:
• HDMI video input is only output to the HDMI
MONITOR OUT terminal of the unit. If connecting
a playback device such as a DVD player to the
HDMI input jack, connect the HDMI MONITOR
OUT terminal of the unit to a TV monitor.
• This mode is unavailable for the REC out terminal.
• This mode is unavailable for still picture, fast
forward and reverse play on video component.
•
If, while attempting to use the video convert
feature, the unit cannot synchronize with the
display device, “NO SIGNAL” appears on the
monitor or noise is generated, this feature cannot
be used. All of these signs are caused by equipment
incompatibility; there is nothing wrong with the unit.
If this occurs, set “VIDEO CONVERT” in the
“VIDEO SETUP” menu to “DISABLE”. Next,
connect the video input signal to the display component
via the MONITOR OUT terminal under VIDEO and
the S-video input signal to the display component via
the MONITOR OUT terminal under S-VIDEO.
• The video convert feature constantly monitors
input video signals and determines whether to
convert the input signals or not. However, some
input video signals cannot be detected correctly.
If this occurs, set “VIDEO CONVERT” in the
“VIDEO SETUP” menu to “DISABLE”.
•
For optimal video performance, THX recommends
setting the “VIDEO CONVERT” mode “DISABLE”.
CONNECTION EXAMPLE
• When a monitor is connected to the HDMI
MONITOR OUT terminal of the unit
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
PURE DIRECT
DSD
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
PURE DIRECTTHX
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
PHONES
VIDEO
or S-VIDEO
or component
or HDMI
Notes:
• If the resolution of the component video signal
input from the playback device is other than 480i,
480p, 1080i or 720p, images are not output from the
HDMI MONITOR OUT terminal of the unit.
• If the resolution of the S-Video or Video signal input
from the playback device is other than 480i, images
are not output from the HDMI MONITOR OUT
terminal of the unit.
• When a monitor is connected to the VIDEO or SVIDEO MONITOR OUT terminals of the unit
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
PURE DIRECT
SLEEP
DSD
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
PURE DIRECTTHX
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
PHONES
VIDEO
or S-VIDEO
or component
HDMI
MULTI
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
ENTER
MENU
SURRDIRECT
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
AUTO
MULTI
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
ENTER
MENU
BAND
MEMORY CLEAR
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
A/B
M-DAX
EXIT
MIC
SURROUND
V-OFFDISPMULTI AUTO TUNED STSPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
NIGHT
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SLS SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
A/B
M-DAX
EXIT
MIC
VOLUME
UP
DOWN
AUX 1 INPUT
DIGITAL
RLVIDEO
S-VIDEO
AUDIO
HDMI
VOLUME
UP
DOWN
AUX 1 INPUT
DIGITAL
RLVIDEO
S-VIDEO
AUDIO
VIDEO
or S-VIDEO
ENGLISH
59
ENGLISH
Notes:
• The HDMI video signal input from the playback
device is not output from the VIDEO or S-VIDEO
MONITOR OUT terminals of the unit.
• If the resolution of the component video signal input
from the playback device is other than 480i, it is not
output from the VIDEO or S-VIDEO MONITOR
OUT terminals of the unit.
• When a monitor is connected to the COMPONENT
VIDEO MONITOR OUT terminal of the unit
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
PURE DIRECT
DSD
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
PURE DIRECTTHX
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
PHONES
VOLUME
UP
DOWN
MULTI
BAND
SPEAKER
MEMORY CLEAR
MULTI
T-MODE
7.1CH INPUT
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
A/B
ENTER
EXIT
MENU
AUX 1 INPUT
DIGITAL
RLVIDEO
S-VIDEO
AUDIO
MIC
VIDEO
or S-VIDEO
component
or component
HDMI
Notes:
• The HDMI video signal input from the playback
device is not output from the COMPONENT
VIDEO MONITOR OUT terminal of the unit.
Notes of OSD menu system:
• The setup menu can be displayed through all
video out terminals (“HDMI”, “COMPONENT”,
“SVIDEO” and “VIDEO”).
• OSD information is output only to the VIDEO and
S-VIDEO MONITOR OUT terminals.
OSD information is also output when the video
conversion feature is on and the video signal input
to the VIDEO or S-VIDEO input jack of the unit
is converted and output from the COMPONENT
VIDEO or HDMI MONITOR OUT terminals.
I/P CONVERT
The video circuit of the unit is equipped with an I/P
conversion feature.
When this feature is on, 480i analog video signals
(VIDEO, S-VIDEO or COMPONENT VIDEO) input
from a playback device can be converted to 480p and
progressively output to the COMPONENT VIDEO or
HDMI MONITOR OUT terminals of the unit.
(For setting instructions, see page 53)
SURROUND MODE
This unit is equipped with many surround modes. These are provided to reproduce a variety of surround sound
effects, according to the content of the source to be played.
The available surround modes may be restricted depending on the input signal and speaker setup.
The relationship between the selected surround mode and the input signal
The surround mode is selected with the surround mode selector on the unit or the remote controller. However,
the sound you hear is subject to the relationship between the selected surround mode and the input signal. That
relationship is as follows:
Surround ModeInput SignalDecoding
AUTODolby Surr.EXDolby Digital EX
SOURCE DIRECT
PURE DIRECT
EX/ESDolby Surr.EXDolby Digital EX
Dolby D (5.1ch)Dolby Digital 5.1
Dolby D (2ch)Dolby Digital 2.0
Dolby D (2ch Surr)Pro Logic IIx movie
Dolby Digital Plus (5.1ch)
Dolby Digital Plus (6.1ch)
Dolby Digital Plus (7.1)
Dolby TrueHD (5.1ch)
Dolby TrueHD (6.1ch)
Dolby TrueHD (7.1ch)
DTS-ESDTS-ES
DTS 96/24DTS-96/24
DTS (5.1ch)DTS 5.1
DTS-HD (5.1)DTS-HD
DTS-HD (6.1)DTS-HD
DTS-HD (7.1)DTS-HD
Multi Ch-PCMMulti Ch-PCM
Multi Ch-PCM 96kHz
SA-CD (5.1ch)Multi Ch-PCM
SA-CD (2ch)PCM (Stereo)
PCM (Audio)PCM (Stereo)
PCM 96kHzPCM (Stereo 96kHz)
HDCDHDCD
AnalogStereo
7.1ch inputMulti Ch
Dolby Surr.EXDolby Digital EX
Dolby D (5.1ch)Dolby Digital 5.1
Dolby D (2ch)Dolby Digital 2.0
Dolby D (2ch Surr)Pro Logic IIx movie
Dolby Digital Plus (5.1)
Dolby Digital Plus (6.1)
Dolby Digital Plus (7.1)
Dolby TrueHD (5.1) DolbyTrueHD
Dolby TrueHD (6.1) DolbyTrueHD
Dolby TrueHD (7.1) DolbyTrueHD
DTS-ESDTS-ES
DTS 96/24DTS-96/24
DTS (5.1ch)DTS 5.1
DTS-HD (5.1)DTS-HD
DTS-HD (6.1)DTS-HD
DTS-HD (7.1)DTS-HD
Multi Ch-PCMMulti Ch-PCM
Multi Ch-PCM 96kHz
SA-CD (5.1ch)SA-CD (5.1ch)
SA-CD (2ch)SA-CD (2ch)
PCM (Audio)PCM (Stereo)
PCM 96kHzPCM (Stereo 96kHz)
HDCDHDCD
AnalogStereo
7.1ch inputMulti Ch
Dolby D (5.1ch)Dolby Digital EX
Dolby Digital Plus (5.1)
Dolby TrueHD (5.1) DolbyTrueHD
DTS-ESDTS-ES
DTS (5.1ch)DTS-ES
Dolby Surr.EXDolby Digital EX
Dolby D (5.1ch)Dolby Digital 5.1
Dolby D (5.1ch)Dolby Digital 5.1 + PLIIx
Dolby D (2ch)Pro Logic IIx
Dolby D (2ch Surr)Pro Logic IIx
Dolby Digital Plus (5.1)
Dolby Digital Plus (6.1)
Dolby Digital Plus (7.1)
Dolby TrueHD (5.1) DolbyTrueHD
Dolby TrueHD (6.1) DolbyTrueHD
Dolby TrueHD (7.1) DolbyTrueHD
Multi Ch-PCMMulti Ch-PCM + PLIIx
SA-CD (5.1ch)Multi Ch-PCM + PLIIx
SA-CD (2ch)Pro Logic IIx
PCM (Audio)Pro Logic IIx
HDCDPro Logic IIx
AnalogPro Logic IIx
DTS-ESDTS 5.1
DTS 96/24DTS-96/24
DTS (5.1ch)DTS 5.1
DTS-HD(5.1)DTS-HD
DTS-HD(6.1)DTS-HD
DTS-HD(7.1)DTS-HD
Dolby D (2ch)Neo:6
Dolby D (2ch Surr)Neo:6
SA-CD (2ch)Neo:6
PCM (Audio)Neo:6
HDCDNeo:6
AnalogNeo:6
Dolby D (2ch)CS
Dolby D (2ch Surr)CS
SA-CD (2ch)CS
PCM (Audio)CS
HDCDCS
AnalogCS
Dolby D (5.1ch)Stereo
Dolby D (2ch)Stereo
Dolby D (2ch Surr)Stereo
Dolby Digital Plus (5.1)
Dolby Digital Plus (6.1)
Dolby Digital Plus (7.1)
Dolby TrueHD (5.1) Stereo
Dolby TrueHD (6.1) Stereo
Dolby TrueHD (7.1) Stereo
DTS-ESStereo
DTS 96/24Stereo
DTS (5.1ch)Stereo
DTS-HD (5.1)Stereo
DTS-HD (6.1)Stereo
DTS-HD (7.1)Stereo
Multi Ch-PCMStereo
Multi Ch-PCM 96kHz
SA-CD (5.1ch)Stereo
SA-CD (2ch)Stereo
PCM (Audio)Stereo
PCM 96kHzStereo
HDCDStereo
AnalogStereo
Dolby Surr.EXDolby Virtual Speaker
Dolby D (5.1ch)Dolby Virtual Speaker
Dolby D (2ch)Dolby Virtual Speaker
Dolby D (2ch Surr)Dolby Virtual Speaker
DTS-ESDolby Virtual Speaker
DTS 96/24Dolby Virtual Speaker
DTS (5.1ch)Dolby Virtual Speaker
Multi Ch-PCMDolby Virtual Speaker
SA-CD (5.1ch)Dolby Virtual Speaker
SA-CD (2ch)Dolby Virtual Speaker
PCM (Audio)Dolby Virtual Speaker
HDCDDolby Virtual Speaker
AnalogDolby Virtual Speaker
Dolby Surr.EXDolby Digital EX
Dolby D (5.1ch)Dolby Digital 5.1
Dolby D (2ch)Multi Channel
Dolby D (2ch Surr)Multi Channel
DolbyDigital +
DolbyDigital +
DolbyDigital +
II
II
II
II
II
II
Stereo
Stereo
Stereo
Stereo
Output ChannelFront information display
L/R C
SLSRSBL
SubW
OOO-O
OOO-O2 DIGITALL, C, R, SL, SR, LFE
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOO-O
OOOOO
OOOOO2 DIGITALL,C,R,SL,SR,S,LFE
OOO-O2 DIGITAL
OOOOO
OOOOO2 DIGITAL
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOO-O
OOO-O
OOO-O
OOO-O
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO2 DIGITAL L, R
OOOOO2 DIGITAL 2 SURROUND L, R, S
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO2 DIGITALL, R
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O (O) O O O
O (O) O
O (O) O O O2 DIGITAL L, R
O (O) O O O2 DIGITAL 2 SURROUND L, R, S
Dolby D (5.1ch)Dolby H.P
Dolby D (2ch)Dolby H.P
Dolby D (2ch Surr)Dolby H.P
Dolby Digital Plus (5.1)
Dolby Digital Plus (6.1)
Dolby Digital Plus (7.1)
Dolby TrueHD (5.1) Stereo
Dolby TrueHD (6.1) Stereo
Dolby TrueHD (7.1) Stereo
DTS-ESDolby H.P
DTS 96/24Dolby H.P
DTS (5.1ch)Dolby H.P
DTS-HD (5.1)Stereo
DTS-HD (6.1)Stereo
DTS-HD (7.1)Stereo
Multi Ch-PCMDolby H.P
SA-CD (5.1ch)Dolby H.P
SA-CD (2ch)Dolby H.P
PCM (Audio)Dolby H.P
HDCDDolby H.P
AnalogDolby H.P
Dolby Surr.EX
Dolby D (5.1ch)
Dolby D (2ch)
Dolby D (2ch Surr)
DTS-ESDTS-ES + THX
DTS (5.1ch)DTS + THX 5.1
Multi Ch-PCMMulti Ch-PCM + THX5.1
SA-CD (5.1ch)Multi Ch-PCM + THX5.1
SA-CD (2ch)
PCM (Audio)
HDCD
Analog
Dolby Surr.EX
Dolby D (5.1ch)Dolby Digital 5.1+ THX
Dolby D (2ch)
Dolby D (2ch Surr)
DTS-ESDTS-ES + THX
DTS (5.1ch)
Multi Ch-PCMMulti Ch-PCM + THX
SA-CD (5.1ch)Multi Ch-PCM + THX
SA-CD (2ch)
PCM (Audio)
HDCD
Analog
Multi Ch-PCM 96kHz
Stereo
Stereo
Stereo
Dolby Digital + THX Surround EX
Dolby Digital 5.1+ THX 5.1
Pro Logic IIx movie + THX
Pro Logic IIx movie + THX
Pro Logic IIx movie + THX
Pro Logic IIx movie + THX
Pro Logic IIx movie + THX
Pro Logic IIx movie + THX
Dolby Digital + THX Surround EX
Select2 Cinema
Pro Logic IIx movie + THX
Pro Logic IIx movie + THX
DTS + THX Select2 Cinema
Select2 Cinema
Select2 Cinema
Pro Logic IIx movie + THX
Pro Logic IIx movie + THX
Pro Logic IIx movie + THX
Pro Logic IIx movie + THX
Notes:
• Dolby Digital (2 channel L/R): Speakers for signal
with Dolby Surround are fully equipped.
• No sound is outputs from the surround speaker,
center speaker and subwoofer if the DVD disc has
no surround data.
• Surround modes other than Stereo are not available
during Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus, or DTSHD playback.
If surround modes other than Stereo are selected
and Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus, or DTSHD content is played, the surround mode setting is
disabled.
Output ChannelFront information display
L/R C
O (O) O O O
O (O) O
O (O) O
O (O) O
O (O) O
O (O) O
O (O) O O O
O (O) O O O
O (O) O O O
O (O) O O O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
OOOOO2 DIGITAL EXL, C, R, SL, SR, S, LFE
OOO-O2 DIGITALL, C, R, SL, SR, LFE
OOOOO2 DIGITAL L, R
OOOOO2 DIGITAL 2 SURROUND L, R, S
OOOOO
OOO-O
OOO-O
OOO-O
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO2 DIGITAL EXL, C, R, SL, SR, S, LFE
OOOOO2 DIGITALL, C, R, SL, SR, LFE
OOOOO2 DIGITAL L, R
OOOOO2 DIGITAL 2 SURROUND L, R, S
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
OOOOO
SLSRSBL
SubW
Signal format indicatorsChannel status
SBR
dts, ESL, C, R, SL, SR, S, LFE
-
O
dts 96/24L, C, R, SL, SR, LFE
-
O
dtsL, C, R, SL, SR, LFE
-
O
PCML, C, R, SL, SR, LFE
-
O
PCML, C, R, SL, SR, LFE
-
O
DSDL, C, R, SL, SR, LFE
DSDL, R
PCML, R
PCM, HDCDL, R
Depend on speaker setup
Depend on speaker setup
Depend on speaker setup
Abbreviations
L/R : Front speakers
C : Center speaker
SL/SR : Surround speakers
SBL/SBR : Surround back speakers
SubW : Subwoofer
ENGLISH
61
ENGLISH
AUTO
When this mode is selected, the unit determines
whether the digital input signal is Dolby Digital,
Dolby Digital Surround EX, Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby
TrueHD, DTS-HD, DTS, DTS-ES, DTS 96/24 or PCM
audio.
Surround EX & DTS-ES will operate for multichannel
sources that have a Dolby Digital Surround EX or
DTS-ES auto trigger fl ag in the digital signal.
When a Dolby Digital or DTS signal is input, the
number of channels for which the corresponding
signal is encoded will be played.
Inputting a Dolby Digital two channel signal with
Dolby surround status automatically subjects that
signal to Pro Logic II x movie processing before play.
PCM 96 kHz source material can be played in this
mode.
Notes:
• When you use this mode with certain DVD and CD
players, performing operations such as skip or stop
may momentarily interrupt the output.
• When the signal is not decoded, the mode is changed
to AUTO mode automatically. See page 60 to
confi rm the available decoding modes.
SOURCE DIRECT
In the Source Direct mode, the tone control circuit
Acoustic EQ. and bass management confi guration
are bypassed for full-range frequency response and
the purist audio reproduction.
Notes:
• Speaker size is set to Front L/R = LARGE, Center =
LARGE, Surround L/R = LARGE and Subwoofer
= YES automatically. Tone controls, equalizer and
additional processing are deactivated.
• When you use this mode with certain DVD and CD
players, performing operations such as skip or stop
may momentarily interrupt the output.
• In SOURCE DIRECT mode, ACOUSTIC EQ and
M-DAX are not available.
PURE DIRECT
The Pure Direct mode further reduces sources of
noise in addition to effect of the Source Direct mode,
by blocking output from the video jacks (VIDEO,
S-VIDEO, COMPONENT VIDEO and HDMI) and
turning the FL display off.
Note:
• In PURE DIRECT mode, ACOUSTIC EQ and MDAX are not available.
EX/ES
This mode provides 6.1 channel surround for Dolby
Digital EX, and DTS-ES-encoded source material
such as DVD.
This mode cannot be used when an analog input has
been selected.
Dolby Digital EX
In a movie theater, fi lm soundtracks that have been
encoded with Dolby Digital Surround EX technology
are able to reproduce an extra channel which has
been added during the mixing of the program.
This channel, called surround back, places sounds
behind the listener in addition to the currently
available front left, front center, front right, surround
right, surround left and subwoofer channels.
This additional channel provides the opportunity
for more detailed imaging behind the listener and
brings more depth, spacious ambience and sound
localization than ever before.
Dolby Digital EX is not available in systems that do
not have without surround back speaker(s).
DTS-ES (Discrete 6.1, Matrix 6.1)
DTS-ES adds the surround center channel audio to
the DTS 5.1 channel format to improve the acoustic
positioning, and makes acoustic image movement
more natural with the 6.1 channel reproduction.
This unit incorporates a DTS-ES-decoder, which
can handle DTS-ES Discrete-encoded and DTS-ES
Matrix-encoded program sources from DVD, etc.
DTS-ES Discrete 6.1 features digital discrete
recording of all channels, including the surround back
channel(s), and higher quality audio reproduction.
DTS-ES is not available in systems that do not have
surround back speakers.
2 MODE
(Dolby Digital, Pro Logic IIx MOVIE, Pro Logic IIx
MUSIC, Pro Logic IIx GAME)
This mode is used with source materials encoded in
Dolby Digital and Dolby Surround.
DOLBY DIGITAL
This mode is enabled when playing source materials
encoded in Dolby Digital.
Playing multichannel-encoded 5.1 channel Dolby
Digital sources provides 5 main audio channels (left,
center, right, surround left and surround right) and a
Low Frequency Effect channel.
Dolby Digital EX decoding is not available in this
mode.
Dolby Pro Logic IIx has 5 modes:
Pro Logic IIx MOVIE
This mode provides 6.1 or 7.1 channel surround
sound from Dolby Surround, encoded stereo movie
soundtracks.
Pro Logic IIx MUSIC
This mode provides 6.1 or 7.1 channel surround
sound from conventional stereo sources (analog or
digital), such as CD, tape, FM, TV, stereo VCR, etc.
Pro Logic IIx GAME
This mode
surround effects by routing them to the system’s
subwoofer.
5.1ch + Pro Logic IIx Movie
This mode provides 7.1 channel surround sound from
5.1 channel sources
5.1ch + Pro Logic IIx Music
This mode provides 6.1 or 7.1 channel surround sound
from 5.1 channel sources music soundtracks.
Notes:
restores the impact low-frequency
movie soundtracks
• Pro Logic IIx mode will decode as Pro Logic II
mode when the SURR. B is set to “NONE” from
SPEAKER SETUP menu. (See page 49)
• Pro Logic IIx mode is available for a 2 channel input
signal which is encoded in Dolby Digital, HDCD or
PCM format.
.
dts
dts, Neo:6 Cinema, Neo:6 Music
This mode is for DTS-encoded source materials
such as laserdisc, CD and DVD. Neo:6 is for some 2
channel sources.
dts
This mode is enabled when playing source materials
encoded in dts multichannel.
Playing multichannel encoded-5.1 channel dts
sources provides five main audio channels (left,
center, right, surround left and surround right) and a
Low Frequency Effects channel.
dts-ES decoding is not available in this mode.
The DTS mode cannot be used when an analog
input has been selected.
Neo:6 Cinema, Neo:6 Music
This mode decodes 2 channel signals into 6 channel
signals using high-accuracy digital matrix technology.
The DTS Neo:6 decoder has near-discrete properties
in the frequency characteristics of the channels as
well as in channel separation.
According to the signals to be played back, DTS Neo:6
uses either the Neo:6 Cinema mode optimized for
movie playback or the Neo:6 Music mode optimized
for music playback.
Note:
The Neo:6 mode is available for 2 channel input
•
signals which are encoded in Dolby Digital, HDCD
or PCM format.
CIRCLE SURROUND II
II
-CINEMA, CSII-MUSIC, CSII-MONO)
(CS
Circle Surround is designed to enable multichannel
surround sound playback of non-encoded and
multichannel encoded material.
Backward compatibility provides listeners with up to
6.1 channels of surround performance from an entire
collection of music and fi lm, including broadcast,
videotape and stereo recorded music.
Depending on source material, you can select CSII -
Cinema mode, CSII-Music mode or CSII-Mono
mode.
Note:
• The CS II mode is available for 2 channel input
signals which are encoded in Dolby Digital, HDCD
or PCM format.
62
STEREO
This mode bypasses all surround processing.
In stereo program sources, the left and right channels
play normally when PCM audio or analog stereo is
input.
With Dolby Digital and DTS sources, the 5.1 channels
are converted to two channel stereo. 96 kHz PCM
source material can be played back in stereo mode.
Dolby Virtual Speaker
Dolby Virtual Speaker technology uses proprietary
technology of Dolby Laboratories to create a virtual
surround sound fi eld using only two speakers for the
front channels, allowing the user to experience sound
as if surround speakers were actually being used.
MULTI CH. (MOVIE, MUSIC)
This mode is used to create a wider, deeper and more
natural soundstage from two channel source material.
This is done by feeding the left channel signal to
both the left front and left surround speakers and the
right channel signal to both the right front and right
surround speakers. Additionally, the center channel
reproduces a mix of the right and left channels.
Note:
• Audio is not output from the CENTER channel
when using MULTI CH. MUSIC mode.
THX CINEMA
THX Cinema mode applies additional processing
to Dolby Digital, DTS and Dolby Pro Logic multichannel, surround sources. The THX processing
was developed by THX Ltd. to recreate the sound of
top-quality theater.
Use the THX Cinema mode for all movies on disc,
tape or broadcast. In this mode, the THX Surround
EX mode is not available.
THX SURROUND EX
In a movie theater, fi lm soundtracks that have been
encoded with Dolby Digital Surround EX technology
are able to reproduce an extra channel which has
been added during the mixing of the program.
This channel, called Surround Back, places sounds
behind the listener in addition to the currently
available front left, front center, front right, surround
right, surround left and subwoofer channels.
This additional channel provides the opportunity
for more detailed imaging behind the listener and
brings more depth, spacious ambience and sound
localization than ever before.
THX Surround EX will operate for any 5.1 channel
source whenever THX is active.
THX Surround EX is not available in system without
surround back speaker(s).
Note:
• When playing Dolby Digital Surround EX-encoded
software in 6.1 channels, it is required to select the
THX Surround EX mode.
THX SELECT2 CINEMA
THX SELECT2 Cinema mode plays 5.1 movies using
all 7.1 speakers giving you the best possible movie
watching experience. In this mode, ASA processing
blends the surround L/R speakers and surround back
speakers, providing the optimal mix of ambient and
directional surround sound.
This mode permits the playback of a non Surround
EX/ES-encoded 5.1 movie over a 7.1 system.
DTS-ES (Matrix and 6.1 Discrete) and Dolby
Digital Surround EX-encoded soundtracks will be
automatically detected, if the appropriate fl ag has
been encoded.
Some Dolby Digital Surround EX soundtracks
are missing the digital fl ag that allows automatic
switching.
If you know that the movie that you are watching is
encoded in Surround EX, you can manually select the
THX Surround EX playback mode, otherwise the THX
SELECT2 Cinema mode will apply ASA processing to
provide optimum replay.
THX MUSIC
For the replay of multichannel music, the THX Music
mode should be selected. In this mode, THX ASA
processing is applied to the surround channels of all
5.1-encoded music sources, such as DTS and Dolby
Digital, to provide a wide, stable, rear soundstage.
This mode is to be used with multichannel music
sources such as DTS 5.1 music and Dolby Digital
5.1 music.
Notes:
• These modes are only available when you have
setup SPEAKER SIZE menu system (i.e. 2 surround
back speakers).
• These modes are only available when the input
signal has surround left and surround right contents.
THX GAMES
For the replay of stereo and multichannel game
audio the THX Games mode should be selected.
In this mode, THX ASA processing is applied to
the surround channels of all 5.1 and 2.0-encoded
game sources such as analog, PCM, DTS and
Dolby Digital. This accurately places all game audio
surround information, providing a full 360-degree
playback environment. THX Games mode is unique
as it gives you a smooth transition of audio in all
points of the surround fi eld.
Neural Surround
Neural SurroundTM represents the latest advancement
in surround technology developed for music.
Neural SurroundTM employs psychoacoustic
frequency domain processing which allows delivery
of a more detailed sound stage with superior channel
separation and localization of audio elements.
System playback is scalable from 5.1 to 7.1 multichannel surround playback.
This is the optimum mode for playing sources
recorded in XM HD Surround. (See page 77)
CAUTION
Note for DTS
•
To connected DVD player, laserdisc player or CD
player needs to support DTS digital output. You
may not be able to play some DTS source signals
from certain CD players and LD players even if
you connect the player to the unit digitally. This is
because the digital signal has been processed
(such as the output level, sampling frequency or
frequency response), and the unit cannot recognize
the signal as DTS data.
• Depending on the player used, DTS play may
produce a short noise. This is not a malfunction.
• While signals from a DTS laserdisc or CD are
playing in another surround mode, you cannot
switch to digital input or from digital input to analog
input from the INPUT SETUP in the MAIN MENU
or by pressing the A/D button.
• You can not listen to DTS-encoded software in a
multiroom.
The outputs for VCR 1 OUT, DSS/VCR 2 OUT,
•
TAPE OUT and CD-R OUT output analog audio
signals only. Do not record from CDs or LDs that
support DTS using these outputs. If you do, the
DTS-encoded signal will be recorded as noise.
Note or Dolby Digital Surround EX
•
When playing Dolby Digital Surround EX-encoded
software in 6.1 channels, it is required to set the
EX/ES mode.
• Note that some Dolby Digital Surround EX-encoded
software does not contain the identifi cation signal.
In this case, set the EX/ES mode manually.
Note for 96 kHz/192 kHz PCM audio
•
The AUTO, Pure Direct, and Stereo modes can be
used when playing PCM signals with a sampling
frequency of 96/192 kHz (such as from DVD-Video/
Audio discs).
•
Certain DVD player models inhibit digital output. For
details, refer to the player’s operation manual.
•
Some DVD discs feature copy protection. When using
such disc, 96 kHz PCM signal are not output from the
DVD player. For details, refer to the player’s operation
manual.
Note for HDCD
•
HDCD is effective only through digital input.
•
You may not be able to play some HDCD source
signals from certain CD players if you connect the
player to the unit digitally. This is because the digital
signal has been processed (such as the output level,
sampling frequency or frequency response) and the
unit cannot recognize the signal as HDCD data.
ENGLISH
63
ENGLISH
S
E
1
OTHER FUNCTION
DISPLAY MODE
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
PURE DIRECT
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
AUTO
DSD
SURROUND
MULTI
SPEAKER
MODE AUTO
MULTIT-MODE
7.1CH INPUT
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
MENU
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
ENTER
PEAK ANALOG
NIGHT
SURROUND
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
BAND
MEMORY
DISPLAY
M-DAX
EXIT
MIC
You can select the display mode for the front display
of the unit.
To select this mode, press the DISPLAY on the
remote controller or the front panel.
When this button is pressed, the display mode is
switched in the following sequence.
Input Mode → Surround Mode → Auto display OFF
→ Display OFF → Normal Mode → Input Mode
Normal Mode:
Displays the selected input function. If the function
has been renamed using the Function Rename
feature (see page 44), the renamed name appears
on the display.
Input Mode:
Displays the input mode set via the Function Input
Setup feature (see page 43).
Surround Mode:
Displays the status of the selected surround
mode.
Auto Display Off mode:
The display is off. But, if you make a change to
the unit such as the input or surround mode, the
display will show that change, then go back to off
after about 3 seconds. When changing the volume,
it is not displayed.
Display Off mode:
The display is off completely.
Note:
• Only the DISP indicator will be illuminated on the
front display in display off condition.
CLEAR
LIP.SYNC
PREV
GUIDE
MENU
TEST
CH.SEL
7.1CH
ATT
DISP
OSD
DISP
7
THX
RECORDING AN ANALOG SOURCE
In normal operation, the audio or video source
selected for listening through this unit is sent to the
record outputs.
This means that any program you are watching
MUTE
EXIT
SURR
231
SPK-AB
564
SLEEP
8097
MEMO
or listening to may be recorded simply by placing
machines connected to the outputs for TAPE OUT, CD/CDR OUT, VCR1 OUT, and DSS/VCR2 OUT in
the record mode.
To record the input source signal you are currently
watching or listening to
1.
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
1. Select the input source to record by turning the
INPUT FUNCTION SELECTOR knob on the
front panel or simply press the input selector
buttons on the remote controller.
The input source is now selected and you may
watch or listen to it as desired.
The currently selected input source signal
2.
is output to the TAPE OUT, CD/CDR OUT,
VCR1 OUT, and DSS/VCR2 OUT outputs for
recording.
Start recording to the recording component as
3.
desired.
PURE DIRECT
DISP MULTI AUTO TUNED
SURR DIRECT
AUTO
SLEEP
DSD
MULTI
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
SPEAK
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
1.
MENU
TV
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
TUNERCDCD-R
TAPE
TAPE
12
AUX1
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
DSS
DSS
VCRDVD
VCRDVD
MD
MD
AMP
AUX2
AUX2
SELECTING ANALOG AUDIO INPUT OR
DIGITAL AUDIO INPUT
M
D1
D2
D3
D3
PAGE
CD
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
D4
4
D5
D5
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
AMP
USE
TUNER
TAPE
12
If you have already assigned the digital inputs, you
can temporarily select the audio input mode for each
input source as following procedures.
Press the AMP button and press the > button until
PAGE4 is displayed. Press the A/D (D3) button.
When this button is pressed, the input mode is
switched in the following sequence.
Auto → HDMI → Digital → Analog → Auto
Auto mode:
The types of signals being input to the digital and
analog input jacks for the selected input source are
detected automatically.
If no digital signal is being input, the analog input
jacks are selected automatically.
HDMI mode:
HDMI mode can be selected only when an HDMI
input has been assigned as an input source.
When “HDMI AUDIO” under PREFERENCE of the
SETUP MENU is set to “THROUGH”, the HDMI
mode cannot be selected.
Digital mode:
The input signal is fi xed to an assigned digital input
terminal.
LISTENING THROUGH HEADPHONES
This jack may be used to listen to the unit’s output
through a pair of headphones. Be certain that the
headphones have a standard 1/4” stereo phono
plug.
Note that the speakers will automatically be turned
off when the headphone jack is in use.
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
PURE DIRECT
DISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SP
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
AUTO
DSD
SURROUND
MULTI
MODE AUTO
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
MENU
Note:
• When using headphones, the surround mode will
change to STEREO and Dolby Headphone by
MENU and Cursor button.
• The surround mode returns to the previous setting
as soon as the headphone plug is removed from the
jack.
DISC 6.
Analog mode:
The analog input jacks are selected.
This selection is temporary and will not be stored in
memory.
To store changes to the input mode, select “1. INPUT SETUP” from the MAIN MENU. (See page 43)
64
DOLBY HEADPHONE MODE
U
E
A
M
This feature simulates the waveforms of the actual
sounds heard from the speakers.
When headphones are used, the MENU button
automatically switches to the Dolby headphone
mode.
The OSD that appears when the MENU button is
pressed is shown below.
HEAD PHONE
DOLBY HP MODE :DH
SURROUND :PL
L LEVEL :+10.0dB
R LEVEL : 0.0dB
DOLBY HP (Headphone) MODE can be selected
with the left and right cursor buttons.
BYPASS → DH (DOLBY Headphone) → BYPASS
BYPASS: Bypasses the Dolby headphone mode
and delivers ordinary 2-channel stereo.
DH: Dolby Headphone is a signal processing
system that delivers a sound similar to
room speakers.
It makes it possible to experience the
volume and space of a 5-channel
surround system using ordinary stereo
headphones.
When the PURE DIRECT mode is selected, Dolby
surround processing is bypassed and “✽✽✽” is
displayed as the mode indication.
The surround mode can be selected when the
modes in DH is selected.
L/R LEVEL can be set in the ±12 dB range.
Notes:
• The surround mode returns to the previous setting as
soon as the plug is removed from the jack.
• In headphone mode, Tone Control and ACOUSTIC
EQ are not available.
II MV
ATTENUATION TO ANALOG INPUT SIGNAL
LIP.SYNC
CLEAR
PREV
MENU
TEST
7.1CH
DISP
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
231
ATT
SPK-AB
ATT
564
5
OSD
SLEEP
8097
THX
MEMO
If the selected analog audio input signal is greater
than the capable level of internal processing, the
“PEAK” indicator will light up on the front display. If
this happens, you should press the ATT button on
the remote controller.
“ATT ” indicator will be illuminated when this function
is activated. The signal-input level is reduced by
about half. Attenuation will not work with the output
signal of TAPE-OUT, CD/CD-R, VCR1-OUT and
DSS/VCR2-OUT.
This function is memorized for each individual input
source.
SPEAKER A/B
CLEAR
LIP.SYNC
PREV
MENU
TEST
7.1CH
DISP
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
231
ATT
SPK-AB
SPK-AB
564
6
OSD
SLEEP
8097
THX
MEMO
LTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
SURR DIRECT
AUTO
MULTI
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
MENU
V-OFF
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
ENTER
PEAK ANALOG
NIGHT
SURROUND
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
A/B
EXIT
MIC
VOLUME
DOWN
AUX 1 INPUT
DIGITAL
VIDEO
S-VIDEO
This unit has speaker system - A and speaker
system- B for front L/R channels.
You can select these systems by pressing
SPEAKERS A/B button on the front panel or SPKAB on the remote controller.
7.1 CH INPUT
This unit is equipped for future expansion through the
use of Multi channel Super Audio CD multichannel
player or DVD-Audio player.
When this is selected, the input signals connected to
the L(front left), R (front right), CENTER, SL (surround
left), SR (surround right) and SBL (surround back left)
and SBR (surround back right) channels of the 7.1
CH. In jacks are output directly to the front (left and
right), center, surround (left and right) and surround
back speaker systems as well as the pre-out jacks
without passing through the surround circuitry.
In addition, the signal input to the SW (subwoofer)
jack is output to the PRE OUT SW (subwoofer) jack.
When 7.1 CH. INPUT is selected, the last video input
used remains routed to the Monitor Outputs.
This permits simultaneous viewing with video
sources
1.2.
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
SURROUND
DIGITAL
LCR
LFE
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
DE
SPEAKERS
M-DAX A/B
MIC
PURE DIRECT
DISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
DISC 6.1
AUTO
DSD
SURROUND
MULTI
MODE AUTO
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
MENU
CH
4.
4.
CLEAR
PREV
MENU
TEST
7.1CH
7.1CH
4
DISP
4.
VOLUME
DOWN
AUX 1 INPUT
DIGITAL
S-VIDEO
AUDIO
3.
2.
UP
RLVIDEO
VOL
OK
LIP.SYNC
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
CH.SEL
231
2
ATT
SPK-AB
564
OSD
SLEEP
8097
THX
MEMO
1. Select a desired Video source to decide the
routed video signal to the Monitor Outputs.
Press the 7.1 CH INPUT button on the front
2.
panel or press 7.1 CH on the remote controller
to switch the 7.1 channel input.
If it is necessary to adjust the output level of
3.
each channel, press the CH.SEL button on the
remote controller.
Adjust the speaker output levels so that you can
hear the same sound level from each speaker
at the listening position. For the front left, front
right, center, surround left, surround right and
surround back speakers, the output levels can
be adjusted between –12 to +12 dB.
The subwoofer can be adjusted between –18
and +12 dB.
These adjustments result will be stored to 7.1
CH. INPUT memory.
Adjust the main volume with the MAIN
4.
VOLUME knob or the VOL buttons on the
remote controller.
To cancel the 7.1 CH. INPUT setting, press the 7.1 CH INPUT button on the front panel or press 7.1 CH
on the remote controller.
Notes:
• When the 7.1 CH. Input is in use, you may not select
a surround mode, as the external decoder determines
processing.
• In addition, there is no signal at the record outputs
when the 7.1 CH. Input is in use.
• Furthermore, the following functions are not
available during 7.1 CH Input use.
Test Tone, NIGHT MODE, Source Direct, Pure
Direct, RE-EQ, Tone Control, Multi EQ
ENGLISH
65
ENGLISH
N
I
O
U
U
U
AUX2 INPUT
If you don’t need to connect 7.1 Ch. input terminals
with multi channel decoder,
L(front left) and R (front right) inputs terminals are
available as AUX2 input.
In this case, You can connect additional audio source
to AUX2 as other audio input terminals.
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
PURE DIRECT
DISP MULTI AUTO
SURR
SLEEP
AUTO
DSD
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
MULTI
7.1CH
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
ME
VIDEO ON/OFF
When no video signal is connected to the unit or
a DVD, etc., is connected directly to your TV, the
unnecessary video circuit can be turned off by
selecting the “VIDEO OFF” setting.
To select video off, press the AMP button and press
the > button until PAGE 4 is displayed. Press the V-
OFF button.
ND RECEIVER SR8002
PURE DIRECT
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
AUTO
DSD
SURROUND
MULTI
MODE AUTO
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
PURE DIRECT THX
NES
MENU
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
ENTER
PEAK ANALOG
NIGHT
SURROUND
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
A/B
EXIT
MIC
USE
PAGE
123
TUNER
CD
AUX1
TAPE
LIGHT
12
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
TV AUTO ON/OFF FUNCTION
This function allows the component connected to the
TV-VIDEO in jack to control the power (ON/OFF) to
the unit.
2. Connect your TV TUNER (etc) to the TVVIDEO in terminal. Be sure to connect the
CH
VOL
VIDEO input.
CLEAR
OK
LIP.SYNC
LIP.SYNC
PREV
MENU
TEST
7.1CH
DISP
MUTE
GUIDE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
231
ATT
SPK-AB
564
OSD
SLEEP
8097
THX
MEMO
Turn OFF the power to the TV TUNER and the
3.
unit.
Turn ON the TV TUNER and tune in a receivable
4.
station.
When the station is received, this unit turns ON
5.
and TV is selected automatically.
AUTO POWER OFF
1. In the above situation, turn the TV TUNER OFF
or select a channel that does not contain any
broadcast.
The power to the unit switches to STANDBY
2.
after approx. 5 minutes.
Notes:
• AUTO POWER OFF is canceled if this unit is set to
a source other than TV.
The function reactivates when TV is selected again.
Note:
• The LIP.SYSNC feature turns OFF (0 ms) in
the SOURCE/PURE DIRECT mode. When the
SOURCE/PURE DIRECT mode is deactivated, the
set value of the LIP.SYSNC feature is automatically
restored.
• Even if you do not correct the time lag manually this
way, audio and video are automatically synchronized
when the unit is connected to TV or Projectors
supporting Auto Lipsync Correction in HDMI 1.3a.
For instructions on Auto Lipsync Correction, see
page 54.
• Some TV broadcasts may cause the TV AUTO
FUNCTION to turn ON.
• The S-Video terminal does not support “TV AUTO
ON/OFF” function.
M
D1
D2
D3
D4
D4
4
D5
D5
LIP.SYNC
Depending on the image device (TV, monitor,
projector, etc.) connected to the unit a time lag can
occur between image signal processing and audio
signal processing. Though minor, this time lag can
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
AMP
interfere with movie and music enjoyment. The LIP.
SYNC feature delays the audio signal with respect to
the image signal output from the SR7001 to correct
the time lag between the sound and image. It can be
DUAL BACKUP MEMORY
The unit stores settings information in nonvolatile
memory even when the main power supply is turned
off. Using the Dual Backup Memory function, you
can write settings information to another memory
area to back up saved settings for recovery anytime
as needed.
BACKUP
Set up the unit in the state for which you want to
store the settings. Hold the MEMORY and ENTER
buttons on the front panel simultaneously for at least
3 seconds.
operated with the “LIP.SYNC” and 1 and 2 cursor
buttons of the remote controller. Set the remote
controller to the AMP mode before operating the
LIP.SYNC feature. The initial setting is OFF (0 ms).
The time lag can be adjusted in 10 ms steps up to
200 ms.
Watch the picture on the image device (i.e., TV,
LTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
SURR DIRECT
AUTO
MULTI
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
MENU
V-OFF
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
ENTER
PEAK ANALOG
NIGHT
SURROUND
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
A/B
M-DAX
EXIT
MIC
VOLUME
DOWN
AUX 1 INPUT
DIGITAL
VIDEO
S-VIDEO
monitor, projector, etc.) as you adjust the time lag.
“MEMORY SAVING” is displayed and the unit’s
settings are saved. The stored settings information
is retained until Dual Backup Memory is used again
and the information is overwritten.
MEMORY SAVING
Note:
• The following settings values cannot be backed
up.
• Main Room Volume
• Multi Room Volume
• Multi Speaker Room Volume
RECOVERY OF MEMORY
Recover backed up settings as follows.
Hold the MEMORY and MENU buttons on the front
panel simultaneously for at least 3 seconds.
RE DIRECT
DSD
PURE DIRECT THX
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
SURR DIRECT
AUTO
SLEEP
MULTI
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
MENU
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
ENTER
PEAK ANALOG
NIGHT
BAND
SURROUND
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
T-MODE
DISPLAY
EXIT
MEMORY CLEAR
M-DAX
MIC
DOWN
SPEAKERS
A/B
DIGITAL
“MEMORY LOAD” is displayed and the unit’s stored
settings are reapplied.
The unit temporarily enters standby mode. If there is
no backup data, “NO BACKUP” is displayed and no
data is recovered.
MEMORY LOAD
NO BACKUP
Note:
• Because the following settings values are
not backed up, each Volume value is set to
Minimum.
• Main Room Volume
• Multi Room Volume
• Multi Speaker Volume
AUTO POWER ON
1. Be sure the TV auto mode is ENABLED. (Refer
to page 53:)
66
BASIC OPERATION
SOURCE
P
P
SOURCE
(TUNER)
To operate the unit from the remote controller, press
the TUNER button on the remote controller so that
the tuner mode is engaged.
LISTENING TO THE TUNER
Frequency scan step for AM is selectable.
(Using the unit)
Turn the INPUT SELECTOR knob to select
1.
“TUNER”.
Press the BAND button to select either FM or
2.
AM.
Press the 3 or 4 cursor buttons on the front
3.
Panel for more than 1 second to start the auto
tuning function.
Automatic searching begins then stops when a
4.
station is tuned in.
URE DIRECT
DSD
PURE DIRECT THX
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
3.2.
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
AUTO
MULTI
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
MENU
M
D1
D1
D2
D2
D3
PAGE
2
CD
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
D4
D5
D5
DSS
VCRDVD
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
SURROUND
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
NIGHT
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
ENTER
A/B
EXIT
MIC
USE
TV
TUNER
TUNER
TAPE
12
1. To select tuner, Press the TUNER button twice
5.
5.
4.
within two seconds on the remote controller.
Press the > button until PAGE 1 is displayed.
2.
Press the BAND (D5) button to select either
3.
FM or AM.
Press the GUIDE on the remote controller,
4.
display will show “FREQ----”.
lnput your desired station’s, frequency with the
5.
1.
ten numbered keypad on the remote
6.
The desired station will automatically be tuned.
controller
ENGLISH
.
Default setup is 10 kHz step, if your country’s
standard is 9 kHz step, Press BAND button on the
front panel or TUNER button on the remote controller
more than 5 seconds. Scan step will change.
Note:
• This function is not available on the SR8002.
Preset memory for the tuner will clear by changing
•
this setup.
AUTO TUNING
M
D1
D2
1.
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
PURE DIRECT
DISP MULTI
SLEEPSAUTO
DSD
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
MU
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
USE
CH
TV
TUNER
TUNER
TAPE
12
3.2.
URE DIRECT
SURR DIRECT
AUTO
SLEEP
DSD
SURROUND
MULTI
SPEAKER
MODE AUTO
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
PURE DIRECT THX
MENU
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
ENTER
PEAK ANALOG
NIGHT
SURROUND
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
A/B
EXIT
MIC
USE
TV
TUNER
TUNER
TAPE
12
PAGE
2
CD
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
PAGE
2
CD
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
D3
D4
D5
D5
D5
VOL
DSS
VCRDVD
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
M
D1
D1
D2
D2
D3
D4
D5
D5
DSS
VCRDVD
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
(Using the remote controller)
1. To select tuner, Press the TUNER button twice
within two second on the remote.
Press the > button until PAGE 1 is displayed.
2.
Press the BAND (D5) button to select either
3.
FM or AM.
Press the > button until PAGE 2 is displayed.
4.
Press and hold the SCAN+ (D1) or SCAN– (D2)
5.
button for 1 second or more.
6. Automatic searching begins then stops when a
station is tuned in.
If tuning does not stop at the desired station, use to
3.
the “MANUAL TUNING” operation.
2.
MANUAL TUNING
1.
5.
5.
1.
USE
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
PURE DIRECT
DISP MULTI
SLEEPSAUTO
DSD
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
CH
TV
MU
TUNER
TUNER
TAPE
12
AUX1
Learning Remote Controller
4.
1.
(Using the unit)
Turn the INPUT SELECTOR knob to select
1.
“TUNER”.
Press the BAND button to select either FM or
2.
AM.
Press the 3 or 4 cursor buttons on the front
3.
Panel to select the desired station.
(Using the remote controller)
To select tuner, press the TUNER button twice
1.
within two seconds on the remote controller.
Press the > button until PAGE 1 is displayed.
2.
Press the BAND (D5) button to select either
3.
FM or AM.
Press the > button until PAGE 2 is displayed.
D2
D3
D4
PAGE
2
D5
D5
D5
VOL
DSS
VCRDVD
CD
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
LIGHT
RC8001SR
4.
Press the SCAN+ (D1) or SCAN– (D2) button
5.
3.
2.
to tune in the deseired station.
DIRECT FREQUENCY CALL
SOURCE
1.
USE
PAGE
CH
OK
LIP.SYNC
PREV
MENU
M
D1
D2
D3
D4
2
3.
D5
D5
D5
VOL
2.
TEST
7.1CH
DISP
CLEAR
TV
TUNER
TUNER
TAPE
12
GUIDE
GUIDE
CH.SEL
231
231
ATT
564
564
OSD
8097
8
THX
0
CD
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
MUTE
4.
EXIT
SURR
SPK-AB
5.
SLEEP
97
MEMO
DSS
VCRDVD
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
1.
67
ENGLISH
G
O
P
D
S
V
6
M
(FM) TUNING MODE (AUTO STEREO OR MONO)
USE
PAGE
2
VCRDVD
TV
TUNER
CD
CD-R
TUNER
AUX2
AUX1
TAPE
LIGHT
12
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
-OFF
.1 EQ
PEAK ANALOG
NIGHT
BAND
SURROUND
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAXRA/B
EXIT
MIC
VOLUME
DOWN
DIGITAL
UP
AUX 1 INPUT
RLVIDEO
S-VIDEO
AUDIO
In TUNER mode, press the T-MODE button on the
remote controller to switch between AUTO STEREO
and monaural sound.
Press the > button on the remote controller to
1.
display Page 2.
Each time the T-MODE (D3) button is pressed,
2.
the TUNER mode changes and the mode is
displayed on the FL display.
Analog / Digital Auto Mode (Only on the SR8002)
T-MODE:DIG-AT
For listening to HD Radio stations.
See p.70 for more information on HD Radio
technology.
Note:
• This mode is not available on the SR7002.
Analog Auto Mode
(when receiving FM broadcasts)
T-MODE:ANA-AT
AUTO STEREO mode is selected and the AUTO
indicator is illuminated on the FL display.
When stereo broadcasts are received, the ST
indicator is illuminated on the FL display.
Note:
• This mode is not available when BAND is set to
AM.
Analog Mono Mode
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D5
T-MODE:MONO
MONO mode is selected and the AUTO indicator
disappears from the FL display. Monaural broadcasts
are received in TUNER mode.
Note:
• On the SR7002, the TUNER mode cannot be
DSS
MD
AMP
changed when BAND is set to AM.
• The SR7002 does not display the mode on the FL
display when the TUNER MODE is switched.
The AUTO indictor appears on the FL display when
the mode is switched to Analog Auto Mode. (See
page 9)
• If the unit receives a weak signal or it is diffi cult to
receive a stereo signal, press the T-MODE button
on the remote controller or the unit to switch to
MONO mode. This reduces the amount of noise
and makes broadcasts easier to hear. The AUTO
PRESET MEMORY
With this unit you can preset up to 60 FM/AM stations
in any order.
For each station, you can memorize the frequency
and reception mode if desired.
AUTO PRESET MEMORY
This function automatically scans the FM and AM
band and enters all stations with proper signal
strength into the memory.
2. 4.
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
PURE DIRECT
DSD
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
1. 3.
SURROUND
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED STSPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
SURR DIRECT
AUTO
NIGHT
SLEEP
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MULTI
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
MENU
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
ENTER
EXIT
MIC
5.
2.
VOLUME
DOWN
A/B
AUX 1 INPUT
DIGITAL
S-VIDEO
indicator on the FL display disappears.
1. To select FM , press the BAND button on the
front panel.
While pressing the MEMORY button, press the
2.
1 cursor button.
“AUTO PRESET” will appear on the display,
MANUAL PRESET MEMORY
3.
IRECT
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
AUTO
D
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
URE DIRECT THX
MENU
(Using the unit)
1. Tune into the radio station you desire (Refer to
UP
RLVIDEO
AUDIO
the “MANUAL TUNING” or “AUTO TUNING”
section).
Press the MEMORY button on the front panel.
2.
“– –“ (preset number) starts blinking on the
display.
Select the preset number by pressing the 1
3.
or 2
(approx. 5 seconds)
Press the MEMORY button again to enter. The
4.
display stops blinking.
The station is now stored in the specifi ed preset
memory location.
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
MULTI
SPEAKER
2. 4.
PREV
MENU
SURROUND
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
NIGHT
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
A/B
M-DAX
ENTER
EXIT
MIC
cursor
buttons, while this is still blinking
TEST
7.1CH
D
DISP
CLEAR
DI
LIP.SYNC
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
231
231
ATT
SPK-AB
564
564
OSD
8097
8
THX
0
3.
SLEEP
97
MEMO
MEMO
2.
and scanning starts from the lowest frequency.
3. Each time the tuner fi nds a station, scanning
will pause and the station will be played for fi ve
seconds.
During this time, the following operations are
possible.
The band can be changed by the BAND button.
4. If no button is pressed during this period, the
current station is memorized in location Preset
01.
If you wish to skip the current station, press the
3 cursor button during this period, this station
is skipped and auto presetting continues.
Operation stops automatically when all 60
5.
(Using the remote controller)
1. Tune into the radio station you desire (Refer to
the “MANUAL TUNING” or “AUTO TUNING”
section).
Press the MEMO button on the remote
2.
controller. “– –“ (preset number) starts blinking
on the display.
Enter the desired preset number by pressing
3.
the numeric buttons.
Note:
• When entering a single digit number (2 for example),
either input “02” or just input “2” and wait for a few
seconds.
preset memory positions are fi lled or when
auto scanning attains the highest end of all
bands. If you desire to stop the auto preset
memory at anytime, press the CLEAR button.
68
M
A
TEST
CH.SEL
SURR
RECALLING A PRESET STATION
CH
TUNERCDCD-R
TUNER
TAPE
12
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
MD
AMP
AUX2
DSS
VCRDVD
TV
1.
2.
CH
PREV
(Using the unit)
Select the desired preset station by pressing
1.
the 1 or 2
cursor
buttons on the front panel.
(Using the remote controller)
Press the TUNER button twice within two
1.
seconds on the remote.
Press the CH+ or CH – button to tune in the
2.
deseired preset station.
Or enter the preset station number with the
numeric buttons.
VOL
OK
LIP.SYNC
MUTE
MUTE
PRESET SCAN
M
D1
PAGE
1 2 3
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
D2
D3
D4
D4
4
D5
D5
MD
AMP
AUX2
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
TUNERCDCD-R
TUNER
TAPE
12
2.
5.
2.
1.
4.
CLEAR
CLEAR
CH
CH
PREV
MENU
TEST
DISP
(Using the remote controller)
Press the TUNER button twice within two
1.
seconds on the remote controller.
Press the > button until PAGE2 is displayed and
2.
press the P-SCAN (D4) on the remote.
“PRESET SCAN” appears on the front display
and then the preset station with the lowest
preset number is recalled fi rst.
Preset stations are recalled in sequence (No.1
3.
VOL
OK
LIP.SYNC
MUTE
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
564
OSD
SLEEP
8097
THX
5.
MEMO
4. You can fast forward the preset stations, press
the CH+ continuously.
When the desired preset station is received,
5.
cancel the preset scan operation by pressing
the CLEAR button or P-SCAN (D4) on the
remote controller.
PRESET CHANNEL LIST DISPLAY
A complete list of the broadcast channels stored in
this unit can be displayed.
M
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
TUNER
TAPE
12
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
MD
AMP
AUX2
1.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
DSS
VCRDVD
1. Press the Tuner button on the remote controller
twice within two seconds to switch to the
TUNER function.
Press > on the remote controller to display
2.
PAGE2, then press P-INFO (D5).
The list of preset channels will be displayed on
3.
the screen of the TV monitor connected to this
unit.
PRESET LIST
NO. 1 FM 87.10 MHzNO. 2 FM 93.10 MHzNO. 3 FM 94.70 MHzNO.10 FM105.70 MHz
RETURN NEXT EXIT
On the SR8002, multicast channels are also
displayed, as shown below, when an HD Radio
channel is set to the preset channels.
PRESET LIST
NO. 1 FM 87.10 MHzNO. 2 FM 93.10 MHzNO. 3 FM 94.70 MHzNO. 4 FM 94.70 MHz-3NO. 5 FM 94.70 MHz-4NO.10 FM105.70 MHz
D1
D2
2.
D3
4.
D4
PAGE
1 2 3
4
D5
D5
2.
4. Up to 10 channels can be displayed at a time.
If there are more than 10 channels, press PINFO (D5) on the remote controller once more
to display the next page.
The list display will disappear automatically in 5
seconds.
CLEARING STORED PRESET STATIONS
You can remove preset stations from the memory
using the following procedure.
3.2.
231
7.1CH
ATT
SPK-AB
564
OSD
SLEEP
97
8
THX
MEMO
MEMO
0
DSS
VCRDVD
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
LTI
KER
ENTER
SURROUND
V-OFFDST SPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
NIGHT
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
A/B
EXIT
MIC
VOLU
DOWN
AUX 1 IN
DIGITAL
S-VIDEO
CLEAR
CLEAR
TV
DISP
1. Recall the preset number to be cleared with
the method described in “Recalling” a preset
station.
Press the MEMORY button on the front panel
2.
or press the MEMO button on the remote.
The stored preset number blinks in the display
3.
for 5 seconds. While blinking, press the
CLEAR button on the front panel or the remote
controller.
4. “xx CLEAR” appears on the display to indicate
that the specified preset number has been
cleared.
Note:
•
To clear all stored preset stations, press and hold the
CLEAR and the ENTER buttons for two seconds.
SORTING PRESET STATIONS
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
If you have stations memorized, and there is a gap in
the sequential order:
I.e. the stations are stored as follows
1) 87.1 MHz
2) 93.1 MHz
3.
2.
3) 94.7 MHz
10) 105.9 MHz
(notice there is no stations programmed for pre sets
for 4-9), you can have pre set 10 become pre set 4:
To sort the numbers, press and hold the MEMORY
and the 4 cursor buttons.
“PRESET SORT” will appear on the display and
sorting will be done.
PURE DIRECT
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
AUTO
DSD
SURROUND
MULTI
MODE AUTO
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
MENU
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
ENTER
PEAK ANALOG
NIGHT
SURROUND
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
A/B
EXIT
MIC
VOLUME
DOWN
DIGITAL
UP
ENGLISH
AUX 1 INPUT
RLVIDEO
S-VIDEO
AUDIO
→ No.2 → etc.) for 10 seconds each.
No stored preset number will be skipped.
In the list of preset channels above, preset
numbers 4 and 5 are the multicast channels for
preset number 3.
69
ENGLISH
SOURCE
VOL
CH
CH
8097
V
6
M
NAME INPUT OF THE PRESET STATION.
This function allows the name of each preset channel
to be entered using alphanumeric characters.
Before name inputting, you need to store preset
stations with the preset memory operation.
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
AUTO
MULTI
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
ENTER
MENU
5.
5.
2.
5.2. 5. 6.
SURROUND
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
NIGHT
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
A/B
EXIT
MIC
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
USE
PAGE
1 2 3
VOLUME
UP
DOWN
AUX 1 INPUT
DIGITAL
RLVIDEO
S-VIDEO
AUDIO
M
4.
D1
D1
D2
D2
D3
4.
D4
4
D5
D5
4.
4.
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
CLEAR
PURE DIRECT
DSD
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
OK
LIP.SYNC
THX
MEMO
MEMO
5.
6.
1. Recall the preset number to be inputted name
with the method described in “Recalling” a
preset station.
Press the MEMORY button on the front panel
2.
or press the MEMO button on the remote
controller for more than 3 seconds.
The left most column of the station name
3.
indicator fl ashes, indicating the character entry
ready status.
When you press the 3 or 4 cursor buttons on
4.
the front panel or the SCAN+ or SCAN– buttons
on the remote controller (page 4), alphabetic
and numeric characters will be displayed in the
following order:
A → B → C ... Z → 1 → 2 → 3 ..... 0 → – → +
→ / → (Blank) → A
UP →
→ DOWN
5. After selecting the fi rst character to be entered,
press the MEMORY or ENTER button, or press
the MEMO button on the remote controller.
The entry in this column is fi xed and the next
column starts to fl ash. Fill the next column the
same way.
To move back and forth between the characters,
press the 1 / 2 cursor buttons or press CH+ or
CH– button on the remote controller.
Note:
• Unused columns should be filled by entering
blanks.
To save the name, press the MEMORY or
6.
ENTER button on the front panel, or press the
MEMO button on the remote controller for more
than 2 seconds.
Instead of using the 3 and 4 cursor buttons
or the SCAN+ and SCAN– buttons of the
remote controller unit to select characters,
characters can be input from the numeric keys
of the remote controller. See the below table
for a correspondence between characters and
numeric keys.
Ten keypadPress, press again, press again, etc.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
A → B → C → 1 → A
D → E → F → 2 → D
G → H → I → 3 → G
J → K → L → 4 → J
M → N → O → 5 → M
P → Q → R → 6 → P
S → T → U → 7 → S
V → W → X → 8 → V
Y → Z → space → 9 → Y
– → + → / → 0
Note:
On the SR8002, when the unit receives HD Radio
and RBDS broadcasts, the HD Radio and RBDS text
data is displayed. Therefore, the preset station names
entered with this function are not displayed.
FOR LISTENING TO HD Radio STATIONS
(SR8002 ONLY)
HD Radio technology brings digital radio to
conventional analog AM and FM radio stations, with
improved sound quality, better reception, and new
data services.
HD Radio technology provides CD-quality sound for
FM stations, and FM-quality sound for AM stations.
In addition, FM HD Radio stations can transmit
multiple programs on the same frequency by using
multicast channels.
Text data display incudes station name, song title,
artist name, and so on.
For more information about HD Radio technology,
visit: www.ibiquity.com
TUNING MODE
HD Radio stations transmit analog and digital signals
for broadcast programs.
You can change the TUNING mode to the desired
signal type.
D1
D2
D3
PAGE
1
CD
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
D4
D5
D5
DSS
VCRDVD
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
USE
TV
TUNER
TUNER
TAPE
12
-OFF
.1 EQ
PEAK ANALOG
NIGHT
SURROUND
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAXRA/B
EXIT
MIC
VOLUME
DOWN
DIGITAL
UP
AUX 1 INPUT
RLVIDEO
S-VIDEO
AUDIO
1. Press the > button on the remote controller to
display Page 2.
Each time the T-MODE (D4) button is pressed,
2.
the TUNER mode changes and the mode is
displayed on the FL display.
Analog/Digital Auto Mode
T-MODE:DIG-AT
Use this mode when listening to HD Radio stations.
(It is recommended that you normally use this
mode.)
AUTO STEREO mode is selected and the AUTO
indicator is illuminated on the FL display.
When stereo broadcasts are received, the ST
indicator is illuminated on the FL display.
When an HD Radio (digital) signal is received, the
DIGITAL indicator is illuminated on the FL display.
Note:
In this mode, if the strength of the HD Radio signal is
weak, the unit automatically changes to Analog mode
to receive the analog signal.
Analog Auto Mode
(when receiving FM broadcasts)
T-MODE:ANA-AT
In this mode, the unit receives only analog signals
and changes to AUTO STEREO mode.
See p.68 for more information on Analog received.
(Only analog broadcasts are received.)
Notes:
• In this mode, HD Radio signals cannot be received.
(Only analog broadcasts are received.)
• This mode is not available when BAND is set to
AM.
Analog Mono Mode
T-MODE:MONO
In this mode, the unit receives only analog signals
and changes to Monaural mode.
See p.68 for more information on Analog Mono
Mode.
Note:
In this mode, HD Radio signals cannot be received.
(Only analog broadcasts are received.)
70
HD RADIO AUTO TUNING
P
1.
URE DIRECT
DSD
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
PURE DIRECT THX
AUTO
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
MENU
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MULTI
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
ENTER
A/B
EXIT
MIC
SURROUND
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
SURR DIRECT
NIGHT
SLEEP
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
CH
PREV
MENU
You can use TUNING mode to scan for HD Radio
stations.
(Using the SR8002)
Press the ENTER button on the front panel.
1.
Automatic searching begins then stops when a
2.
station is tuned in.
(Using the remote controller)
Press the OK button on the remote controller.
1.
Automatic searching begins then stops when a
2.
station is tuned in.
Notes:
• When TUNING mode is set to a mode other than
Analog/Digital Auto mode (DIG-AT), TUNING
mode automatically changes to Analog/Digital Auto
mode.
• If tuning does not stop at the desired station, use
manual tuning. (See p.67 for the manual tuning
operation.)
VOL
VOL
OK
LIP.SYNC
GUIDE
1.
MUTE
EXIT
SWITCHING HD-RADIO INFORMATION INTHE FRONT
PANEL FL DISPLAY
• When the unit receives a broadcast with multicast
channels, the multicast program number (
H
D 1) is
displayed to the right of the station name displayed
on the FL display.
H
When (
D 1) is displayed, you can select the multicast
channel. (See p.72 for information on multicast
channels.)
When the Text 1 (Artist name) is displayed:
TXT1
↓
Pink Floid
The “TXT1” is displayed for 2 seconds, followed by
the artist’s name. If artist’s name is more than 13
characters long, the text is scrolled.
Notes:
• If the signal from an radio station is weak, text data
may be displayed intermittently or not all.
• When the unit receives an analog broadcast not from
an HD Radio station but from an RBDS station, the
radio text is displayed on the FL display. (See p.73
for information on RBDS.)
WhentheText2(Songtitle)isdisplayed:
TXT2
↓
Money
CHECKINGTHEHDRadioSIGNALSTRENGTH
HD SIG:777777
• The HD Radio signal strength of the FL display
changes as shown below according to the
receiving condition.
HD SIG: ■■■■■■SIGNAL: STRONG (Signal strength is good)
HD SIG: ■■■■SIGNAL: MARGINAL (Signal strength is Marginal)
HD SIG: ■■SIGNAL: WEAK (Signal strength is poor)
HD SIG:
SIGNAL: NON (Loss of the signal)
ENGLISH
The “TXT 2” is displayed for 2 seconds, followed by
When the unit is tuned to an HD Radio station,
the station name (call sign) is displayed on the FL
display.
the song title. If song title is more than 13 characters
long, the text is scrolled.
Notes:
• If the signal from an radio station is weak, text data
Notes:
• The station name is displayed if the text data from
the HD Radio station can be received. If the signal
from the radio station is weak, text data may be
displayed intermittently or not all.
may be displayed intermittently or not all.
• When the unit receives an analog broadcast not from
an HD Radio station but from an RBDS station,
the program service name is displayed on the FL
display. (See p.73 for information on RBDS.)
If the text data cannot be received, the frequency
is displayed. The station name is displayed if it has
been registered with the preset station name input
function.
4. Press the OSD button again. The information
display will go out.
SELECTING MULTICAST CHANNELS
FM HD Radio stations can transmit multiple programs
on the same frequency by using what are called
MULTICAST CHANNELS.
1.
M
RE DIRECT
DSD
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
PURE DIRECT THX
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
AUTO
MULTI
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
MENU
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
ENTER
PEAK ANALOG
NIGHT
SURROUND
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
A/B
EXIT
MIC
USE
PAGE
2
(Using the SR8002)
Press the 3 or 4 cursor buttons on the front
1.
panel to select the desired Multicast Channel.
(Using the remote controller)
Press the > button until PAGE 2 is displayed.
1.
Press the SCAN+ (D1) or SCAN- (D2) button
2.
to tune in the deseired Multicast channel.
When the unit receives multicast channels, the
multicast program number (
H
2) is displayed to
D
the right of the station name displayed on the
FL display.
FM WXYZ-FM 2
• This function is not available for AM HD Radio
stations because they cannot broadcast multicast
channels.
• If the received HD Radio station have multicast
channels, the unit scans for frequencies as shown
below.
2.
D1
D1
D2
D2
D3
2.
D4
D5
D5
1.
H
D
Example:
When two multicast channels are broadcast by an
HD Radio station at 100.10 MHz
Unit receives 99.90 MHz.
1.
↓ (Press [SCAN +].)
Unit receives the main channel of the HD Radio
2.
station at 100.10 MHz.
↓ (Press [SCAN +].)
Unit receives multicast channel 1 at 100.10
3.
MHz.
↓ (Press [SCAN +].)
Unit receives multicast channel 2 at 100.10
4.
MHz.
↓ (Press [SCAN +].)
Unit receives 100.30 MHz.
5.
(The station at 100.10 MHz does not have a
third multicast channel, so the next frequency
(100.30 MHz) is received.)
Notes:
• If digital audio data cannot be received after the
station is selected, or if the station signal is weak,
the unit may not be able to receive the multicast
channels.
• If the station signal is weak, the digital audio of
the multicast channel may cut out. In this case,
“LOADING” is displayed on the FL display.
• If the digital signal of the multicast channel cannot
be received, “OFF AIR” is displayed on the FL
display and the main channel is selected.
• Multicast channels cannot be received on AM
broadcasts.
PTY AUTO SEARCH
You can use the Program Type information search
function for some HD Radio stations. See PTY AUTO
SEARCH on p.73.
72
Note:
• When the entire TXT1 or TXT2 character string
cannot be displayed at once, the display changes
to scrolling display. If text data cannot be received,
“---” is displayed.
RBDS OPERATION (SR8002 ONLY)
V
RBDS (Radio Broadcast Data System) is a description
of the station’s programming hidden space in the FM
signal.
Your new unit is equipped with RBDS to assist in the
selection of FM stations using station and network
names, rather than broadcast frequencies. Additional
RBDS functions include the ability to search for
programme types.
Note:
When the unit is receiving an HD Radio (digital)
signal, the HD Radio text data is displayed instead of
the RBDS data.
RADIO TEXT
Some RBDS stations broadcast RADIO TEXT,
which is additional information on the station and
programme being broadcast.
RADIO TEXT information appears as ‘running’ text
in the display. RADIO TEXT is transmitted character
by the radio station. As a result of that it may take
some time until the entire text has been completely
received.
RBDS DISPLAY
When a unit is tuned to an FM station that is
transmitting RBDS data, the Front Panel Information
Display will automatically show the call sign or RBDS
TEXT in place of the typical display of the station’s
broadcast frequency.
To change the display, press the TUNER button and
press the the > button until PAGE3 is displayed.
Select the information with the DISP (D1) button.
Auto display mode
Text 1 (Radio Text)
Text 2 (Program Service name)
HD Radio signal strength
Frequency
When the auto display mode is displayed:
FM WXYZ
When the unit is tuned to an RBDS station, the station
name (call sign) is displayed on the FL display.
Notes:
When the unit receives the RDBS text data from a
station, the station name is displayed. If the signal
from the radio station is weak, text data may be
displayed intermittently or not all.
If the text data cannot be received, the frequency is
displayed. You can use the preset station name input
function to register the station name. The registered
station name is then displayed.
(See p.70 for information on the PRESET STATION
NAME INPUT function.)
When the Text 1 (Radio Text) is displayed:
TXT1
↓
Pink Floid
The “TXT1” is displayed for 2 seconds, followed by
the Radio Text (RT). If RT is more than 13 characters
long, the text is scrolled.
Notes:
• If the signal from an radio station is weak, text data
may be displayed intermittently or not all.
• When the unit is tuned to an HD Radio station, the
artist name is displayed on the FL display. (See p.71
for information on HD Radio technology.)
The “TXT 2” is displayed for 2 seconds, followed by
the Program Service (PS). If PS is more than 13
characters long, the text is scrolled.
Notes:
• If the signal from an radio station is weak, text data
may be displayed intermittently or not all.
• When the unit is tuned to an HD Radio station, the
song title is displayed on the FL display.
(See p.71 for information on HD Radio technology.)
CHECKINGTHEHDRadioSIGNALSTRENGTH
HD SIG:
• The signal strength is only displayed when the unit
is tuned to a digital HD Radio station. “SIGNAL:
NON” is displayed when receiving an analog
signal.
• You can view the tuner information on a TV monitor
when connected to the SR8002. (See p.33, 34 for
the operation details.)
PTY AUTO SEARCH
Your unit is equipped to automatically search for
stations transmitting any of 29 different programme
types. To search for a PTY, follow these procedures:
2.
LEARN
NAME
MACRO
SURROUND
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
SURR DIRECT
AUTO
NIGHT
SLEEP
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
UND
MULTI
SPEAKER
E AUTO
IRECT THX
BAND
MULTI
T-MODE
DISPLAY
7.1CH INPUT
ENTER
EXIT
MENU
MEMORY CLEAR
M-DAX
MIC
DOWN
SPEAKERS
A/B
DIGITAL
S-
1. Press the PTY button in the TUNER MODE on
the remote controller. The current station’s PTY
will be displayed, or the currently selected PTY
group will be displayed in blinking if no station
or RBDS data is present.
To change to a new PTY type, press the
2.
TUNING 3 or 4 button on the front panel or
numeric buttons on the remote controller until
the desired PTY is shown in the display.
3. Once the desired PTY group or type has
been selected, press the PTY button while
the display blink (approx. 5 seconds). The
PTY Auto search will start, and the tuner will
pause at each station broadcasting RBDS
PTY information corresponding to the selected
choice.
To advance to the next RBDS station with the
4.
desired PTY, press the PTY button again within
5 seconds.
Notes:
• Not all RBDS stations and HD Radio stations
broadcast PTY information.
• PTY AUTO SEARCH may not function for stations
with weak signals if the unit is unable to detect the
information needed for the search.
CLEAR
USE
MENU
TEST
7.1CH
DISP
M
D1
1.
D2
D2
D3
3.
D4
PAGE
1 23
4
CH.SEL
231
231
ATT
564
564
OSD
8097
8
THX
0
4.
D5
D5
EXIT
SURR
SPK-AB
2.
SLEEP
97
MEMO
NUMBER DISPLAYPROGRAMME TYPE
1NEWSNews
2INFORMInformation
3SPORTSSports
4TALKTalk
5ROCKRock
6CLS ROCKClassic Rock
7ADLT HITAdult Hits
8SOFT RCKSoft Rock
9TOP 40Top 40
10COUNTRYCountry
11OLDIESOldies
12SOFTSoft
13NOSTALGANostalgia
14JAZZJazz
15CLASSICLClassical
16R & BRhythm and Blues
17SOFT R&BSoft Rhythm and Blues
18LANGUAGEForeign Language
19REL MUSCReligious Music
20REL TALKReligious Talk
21PERSNLTYPersonality
22PUBLICPublic
23COLLEGECollege
24WEATHERWeather
25ALERT!Emergency
26TRAFFICTraffi c
27GOVERMNTGovernment
28EMERGNCYEmergency
29READSVCSRadio Reading Services
30PRIVSVCSPrivate Services
ENGLISH
73
ENGLISH
M
T
LISTENING TO XM SATELLITE RADIO
SELECTING AN INPUT SOURCE
Before you can listen to XM Satellite Radio, you must
fi rst select the input source on the unit.
1.
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
PHONES
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
PHONES
PURE DIRECT
DISP MULTI
SLEEP AU
DSD
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
PURE DIRECT THX
PURE DIRECT
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1
AUTO
DSD
SURROUND
MULTI
MODE AUTO
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
PURE DIRECT THX
MENU
(Using the unit)
Turn the INPUT SELECTOR knob to select
1.
“TUNER”.
Press the BAND button to select either XM or
2.
DAB.
(Using the remote controller)
To select tuner, Press the TUNER button twice
1.
within two seconds on the remote controller.
Press the > button until PAGE 1 is displayed.
2.
Select XM or DAB with the D3 button.
USE
TV
TUNER
CD
TUNER
AUX1
TAPE
12
Learning Remote Controller
2.
SURROUND
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
NIGHT
EQ
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
A/B
ENTER
EXIT
MIC
PAGE
1
VCRDVD
CD-R
AUX2
LIGHT
RC8001SR
DOWN
DIGITAL
CHECKING THE XM SIGNAL STRENGTH
AND RADIO ID
Adjust the antenna location until signal strength
3.
is good.
Select channel 0 (XM000) with the 3 or 4
4.
cursor buttons of the unit or the SCAN + or
POWER
OFF
ON/OFF
ON
M
D1
D2
2.
D3
D3
D4
D5
D5
2.
DSS
MD
AMP
1.
1. Press the > button until PAGE 3 is displayed.
Press the D1 (DISP) button four times to
2.
SOURCE
M
2.
D1
D1
D2
D3
USE
D4
PAGE
23
4
D5
D5
1.
display the signal status on the front display of
the unit.
SCAN – buttons of the remote controller.
4.
8002
PURE DIRECT
DSD
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
PURE DIRECT THX
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
AUTO
MULTI
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
MENU
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1
SURROUND
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
NIGHT
EQ
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
ENTER
A/B
EXIT
MIC
• The Radio ID is displayed.
OFF
POWER
ON/OFF
ON
SOURCE
M
D1
D1
D2
D2
D3
USE
D4
PAGE
2
D5
D5
XMOOORADIO ID
SIGNAL:
VOLUME
UP
AUX 1 INPUT
RLVIDEO
S-VIDEO
AUDIO
• The display changes as shown below according to
the receiving condition.
SIGNAL: ■■■■■■SIGNAL: STRONG (Signal strength is good)
Note:
If “ANTENNA” appears in the front panel display,
•
the XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock may not be
connected to the XM terminal on the rear panel of
this unit properly.
SWITCHING XM INFORMATION IN THE FRONT
PANEL DISPLAY
You can display XM information (such as artist name/
song title, category or signal status) for the channel
currently selected in the front panel display.
POWER
OFF
ON/OFF
ON
SOURCE
M
2.
D1
4.
4.
USE
D1
D2
D3
D4
PAGE
23
4
D5
D5
1.
1. Press the > button until PAGE 3 is displayed.
Select the information with the DISP (D1)
2.
button.
Channel number/name
Artist name/Song title
Channel category
Signal Status
SIGNAL: ■■■■SIGNAL: MARGINAL (Signal strength is Marginal)
SIGNAL: ■■
When the Channel number/name mode is displayed:
XMO40:DeepTrc
SIGNAL: WEAK (Signal strength is poor)
XM NO SIGNAL
40:DeepTracks
SIGNAL: NON (Loss of the signal)
(If text is more than 13 characters long, the text is
scrolled.)
74
When the Artist name/Song title is displayed:
L
S
D
B
A
NAME/TITLE
Pink Floid /
Floid / Money
The “NAME/TITLE” is displayed for 2 seconds,
followed by the artist’s name and song title.
(If artist’s name or song title is more than 13 characters
long, the text is scrolled.)
When the channel category is displayed:
CAT:Rock
Note:
• To change the display content from XM information
to unit functions, do so from the display mode.
(See “DISPLAY MODE” on page 47)
This XM information can also be displayed on a TV
monitor connected to the unit.
TEST
CH.SEL
CH.SEL
231
ATT
564
OSD
OSD
8097
8
THX
CD
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
SURR
SURR
SPK-AB
2.
SLEEP
MEMO
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
AMP
1.
TEST
7.1CH
DISP
DISP
CLEAR
TUNER
TAPE
12
1. Press the AMP button on the remote
controller.
Press the OSD button. The following infor mation
2.
display will be output.
VIDEO :DVD
AUDIO :XM
SURR-MODE :AUTO
MULTIROOMA:ON SPK:OFF
MULTIROOMB:OFF SPK:OFF
MAIN VOLUME
-------------------
3. When this display appears, press the OSD
button again. XM information like the following
will appear.
XM INFORMATION
XM :040
CHAN :DeepTracks
NAME :Pink Floid
TITLE :Money
CAT :Rock
SIGNAL:MARGINAL
SEARCH MODE
You can search for the channel you want to listen to
using one of three search modes. You can also enter
the number directly to select the desired channel.
ALL CHANNEL SEARCH MODE
M
3.
D1
D1
D2
PAGE
2
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
D2
D3
3.
D4
D5
D5
2.
DSS
VCRDVD
MD
AMP
AUX2
1.
1.
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
R
PURE DIRECT
DSD
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1
AUTO
MULTI
SPEAKER
MULTIT-MODE
7.1CH INPUT
MENU
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
NIGHT
EQ
AAC
PCM
BAND
DISPLAY
ENTER
EXIT
(Using the unit)
Press the 3 or 4 cursor button on the front
1.
panel to select the desired station.
(Using the remote controller)
Press the TUNER button twice within two
1.
seconds on the remote controller.
Press the > button until PAGE 4 is displayed.
2.
Press and hold the SCAN+ (D1) or SCAN− (D2)
3.
button.
USE
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
TUNER
TAPE
12
PRESET SEARCH MODE
CH
CH
VOL
1.
2.
RECT
SURR DIRECT
AUTO
SLEEP
URROUND
MULTI
SPEAKER
MODE AUTO
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
RE DIRECT THX
MENU
(Using the unit)
Press the 1 or 2 cursor button on the front
1.
panel to select the desired preset station.
(Using the remote controller)
Press the TUNER button twice within two
1.
seconds on the remote controller.
CH+ or CH− button to tune in the desired
2.
preset station.
Or enter the preset station number with the
numeric buttons.
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1
SURROUND
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
NIGHT
EQ
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLE
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAK
M-DAX
ENTER
A/
EXIT
MIC
OK
LIP.SYNC
PREV
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
TUNER
TAPE
12
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
MUTE
MUTE
DSS
VCRDVD
MD
AMP
AUX2
1.
ENGLISH
4. Press the OSD button again. The information
display will go out.
Note:
If the information contains a character that cannot
•
be recognized by that unit, the character will be
displayed with “ ”(space).
75
ENGLISH
CATEGORY SEARCH MODE
You can select the desired channel from the category
allocated to each channel.
Category being aired can be only selected.
IRECT
D
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
URE DIRECT THX
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
AUTO
MULTI
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
MENU
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1
SURROUND
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
NIGHT
EQ
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
ENTER
A/B
EXIT
MIC
USE
PAGE
2
4
CH
VCRDVD
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
TUNER
AUX2
AUX1
TAPE
LIGHT
12
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
(Using the unit)
Press the ENTER button on the front panel.
1.
Press the 1 or 2 button on the front panel to
2.
select the desired Category.
After selecting the Category, Press the 3 or 4
3.
cursor button to select the desired station of the
category.
You can return to the normal mode by press the
4.
ENTER button during Category Search Mode.
(Using the remote controller)
Press the TUNER button twice within two
1.
seconds on the remote controller.
Press the > button until PAGE 4 is display.
2.
Press the CAT+ (D4) or CAT− (D5) button.
3.
After selecting the category, Press the SCAN+
4.
(D1) or SCAN− (D2) button to select the
desired station of the category.
You can return to the normal mode by press the
5.
OK button during Category Search Mode.
Note:
• Category search ends automatically about 5 seconds
after the last operation.
CHANNEL DIRECT CALL
You can select the desired channel by directly tapping
the numeric keypads on the remote controller.
LIP.SYNC
PREV
M
4.
D1
D1
4.
D2
D2
D3
3.
D4
D4
3.
D5
D5
D5
2.
VOL
DSS
MD
AMP
1.
MENU
TEST
7.1CH
DISP
CLEAR
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
TUNER
TAPE
12
GUIDE
GUIDE
CH.SEL
231
231
ATT
564
564
OSD
8097
8
THX
0
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
MUTE
2.
EXIT
SURR
SPK-AB
3.
SLEEP
97
MEMO
DSS
VCRDVD
MD
AMP
AUX2
1.
PRESET MEMORY
You can store the desired channel in the Preset
Memory.
(You can preset 60 XM Radio stations in addition to
FM/AM stations.)
E DIRECT
DSD
SURROUND
PURE DIRECT THX
MODE AUTO
3.
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
AUTO
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
MENU
2. 4.
LIP.SYNC
PREV
MENU
SURROUND
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
NIGHT
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1
EQ
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MULTI
SPEAKER
MEMORY CLEAR
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
ENTER
A/B
EXIT
MIC
TEST
7.1CH
DISP
CLEAR
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
231
231
ATT
SPK-AB
564
564
OSD
SLEEP
97
8097
8
THX
MEMO
MEMO
0
CHECKING THE XM PRESET CHANNEL
The preset channel can be checked on the on screen
display.
D3
D4
3.4.
D5
D5
D5
VOL
2.
DSS
MD
AMP
1.
3.
2.
USE
PAGE
2
CH
VCRDVD
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
TUNER
AUX2
AUX1
TAPE
LIGHT
12
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
(Using the remote controller)
1. Press the TUNER button twice within two
seconds on the remote controller.
Press the GUIDE.
2.
“XM - - -” will appear on the display.
Input the three digit number for your desired
3.
Channel with the numeric keypad on the
remote controller.
The desired channel will automatically be
4.
tuned.
Note:
If there is no input on the keypad for 5sec., the input
•
is cancelled to return to the original display
Notes:
“LOADING” is displayed while receiving the
•
channel or information.
•
“UPDATING” is displayed while updating encryption
code.
•
When the selected channel is not available, “XM - -
-” is dispIayed.
•
“OFF AIR” is displayed while air is suspended (e.g.
midnight).
(Using the unit)
Tune into the desired channel.
1.
Press the MEMORY button on the front panel.
2.
”- -” (preset number) starts blinking on the
dispIay.
--XM040
3. Select the preset number by pressing the 1
or 2 cursor buttons, While this is still blinking
(approx. 5 seconds)
01XM040
4. Press the MEMORY button again to enter.
The display stops blinking.
The station is now stored in the specifi ed preset
memory location.
(Using the remote controller)
Tune into the desired channel.
1.
Press the MEMO button on the remote
2.
1. Press the TUNER button twice within two
seconds on the remote controller.
The preset channel indication disappears in about 5
sec.
controller. “- -” (preset number) starts blinking
on the display.
Enter the desired preset number by pressing
3.
the numeric buttons.
Note:
When entering a single digit number (2 for example),
•
either input “02” or just input “2” and wait for a few
seconds.
76
PRESET SCAN
X
V
M
D1
D2
D3
3.5.
D4
PAGE
2
CD
AUX1
LIGHT
RC8001SR
Learning Remote Controller
D4
D5
D5
DSS
VCRDVD
CD-R
MD
AMP
AUX2
USE
TV
TUNER
TUNER
TAPE
12
2.
5.
1.
CH
CH
PREV
MENU
TEST
7.1CH
DISP
1. Press the TUNER button twice within two
seconds on the remote controller.
Press the > button until PAGE 2 is displayed.
2.
press the P-SCAN (D4) button on the remote
3.
controller. “PRESET SCAN” appears on the
display and then the preset station with the
lowest preset number is recalled fi rst.
Preset stations are recalled in sequence (No.1
4.
→ No.2 → etc.) for about 5-10 seconds each.
The time changes by the received condition. No
stored preset number will be skipped.
Pressing the CH+ button during prescanning
5.
speeds up scanning.
Also, pressing the CH– button returns to the
previous preset station.
When the desired preset station is received,
cancel the preset scan operation by press the
P-SCAN (D4) button.
VOL
OK
LIP.SYNC
MUTE
GUIDE
EXIT
CH.SEL
SURR
231
ATT
SPK-AB
564
OSD
SLEEP
CLEARING STORED PRESET STATIONS
You can remove preset stations from the memory
using the following procedure.
3.2.
TEST
CH.SEL
SURR
231
7.1CH
ATT
SPK-AB
SURROUND
V-OFFST SPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
NIGHT
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1
EQ
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
R
BAND
T-MODE
DISPLAY
ENTER
EXIT
MEMORY CLEAR
M-DAX
MIC
DOWN
SPEAKERS
A/B
AU
DIGITAL
S-VIDEO
1. Recall the preset number to be cleared with
the method described in ”PRESET SEARCH MODE”.
Press the MEMORY button on the front panel
2.
or Press the MEMO button on the remote
controller.
The stored preset number blinks in the display
3.
for 5 seconds. WhiIe blinking, Press the CLEAR
button on the front panel or the remote.
“xx CLEAR” appears on the dispIay to indicate
4.
that the specified preset number has been
cleared.
Note:
• To clear all stored preset stations, press and hold the
CLEAR and the ENTER buttons for two seconds.
• There are 60 preset channels prepared at the factory
default. The 60 channels are all set to “CHANNEL
001”. Each channel can be stored in the preset
memory. You can search for only the preset
channels.
564
DISP
OSD
8097
THX
CLEAR
CLEAR
CLEAR
TV
TUNERCDCD-R
SLEEP
3.
MEMO
MEMO
MEMO
2.
DSS
VCRDVD
MD
NEURAL SURROUND MODE
When the XM Satellite Radio broadcast received
supports XM HD Surround Sound, Surround playback
is possible in Neural Surround mode.
M
D1
D2
D3
2.
D4
USE
1. Press the > button until PAGE 2 is displayed.
Press the NEURAL (D4) button to tune in the
2.
Neural surround mode.
Note:
For information on Neural Surround, see page 63.
D4
PAGE
1
D5
D5
1.
ENGLISH
77
ENGLISH
MULTI ROOM
SYSTEM
The Multiroom System mode allows the same source
or different sources to be heard in two rooms other
than where this unit is installed.
To use the multiroom system, connect the audio from
the MULTI OUT A and B AUDIO output terminals to
the MULTI ROOM A and B amps.
Note:
• The SR7002 does not have a MULTI ROOM B
setting.
Connect the VIDEO output (MULTI OUT) terminal to
the monitor in Room A.
(MULTI VIDEO OUT terminal is linked to the source
selector in Multi Room A.)
If a surround channel back speaker or speaker C
(see page 38) are not used in the room where this
unit is installed, the multi speaker system can be
used with the amp for the surround back channel.
Also, the COMPONENT VIDEO MONITOR OUT 2
terminal can be used for the monitor output of Room
A.
(This feature cannot be used with the SR7002.)
This unit supports multiroom system functions such
as source selectors, OSD menu systems, sleep
timers and remote control.
MULTI ROOM PLAYBACK USING THE MULTI
ROOM OUT TERMINALS
2.1.
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
PURE DIRECT
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
AUTO
DSD
SURROUND
MULTI
MODE AUTO
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
MENU
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
ENTER
PEAK ANALOG
NIGHT
BAND
SURROUND
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
A/B
EXIT
MIC
1. Pressing the MULTI button on the unit one
time accesses the MULTI ROOM A settings.
Pressing it two times accesses the MULTI
ROOM B settings. Then, pressing it a third time
turns the multiroom feature off. (The SR7002
does not have a MULTI ROOM B setting.)
When the MULTI ROOM setting mode is
2.
engaged, one of the following screens appears
on the display for 10 seconds.
– SR8002 –
* Display when MULTI ROOM A is selected
MA DVD -18dB
* Display when MULTI ROOM B is selected
MB DVD -18dB
VOLUME
DOWN
AUX 1 INPUT
DIGITAL
S-VIDEO
MULTI ROOM PLAYBACK USING THE MULTI
SPEAKER TERMINALS
This unit allows you to connect another set of
speakers and place them in a different room or
separated area for Iistening to music.
2.1.
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
INPUT SELECTOR
LVIDEO
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
1. Pressing the MULTI SPEAKER button on the
unit one time accesses the MULTI SPEAKER
A settings. Pressing it two times accesses the
MULTI SPEAKER B settings. Then, pressing it
a third time turns the MULTI SPEAKER feature
off.
(The SR7002 does not have a MULTI SPEAKER
B setting.)
When the MULTI SPEAKER setting mode is
2.
engaged, one of the following screens appears
on the display for 10 seconds.
– SR8002 –
* Display when MULTI SPEAKER A is selected
MSA DVD -18dB
PURE DIRECT
SURR DIRECT
SLEEP
AUTO
DSD
SURROUND
MULTI
MODE AUTO
SPEAKER
MULTI
7.1CH INPUT
PURE DIRECT THX
PHONES
MENU
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1 EQ
ENTER
PEAK ANALOG
NIGHT
BAND
SURROUND
ATT
DIGITAL
DIGITAL
LCR
LFE
AAC
PCM
SL S SR
MEMORY CLEAR
T-MODE
DISPLAY
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
A/B
EXIT
MIC
– SR7002 –
M-ROOM SPKR
↓
SELECT SOURCE
3. Select an input source with the INPUT
VOLUME
DOWN
AUX 1 INPUT
DIGITAL
LVIDEO
S-VIDEO
SELECTOR knob.
Turn the VOLUME knob to set the volume of
4.
the room used in the multiroom system as you
like.
Note:
• The sleep timer, monaural output and other features
can also be set using the MAIN MENU. (See page
55.)
Notes for Multi Room Speaker
• The Multiroom Speaker mode can be set for only
one of the rooms, A or B.
• The MULTI ROOM SPEAKER output terminals can
be used when Surround Back Speaker = “NONE”
in the SPEAKER SETUP menu. (See SPEAKER
SETUP, page 45)
• “The Surr. Back Speakers are in use” is displayed
when the MULTI SPEAKER button is pressed
when the Surround Back Speaker is not set to
“NONE” in the SPEAKER SETUP menu. (See
SPEAKER SETUP, page 45)
• The Multispeaker mode cannot be used at the
same time as the speaker C. When connecting for
multiroom use, set the SPEAKER C selector switch
on the rear panel to OFF.
78
– SR7002 –
SELECT SOURCE
3. Select an input source with the INPUT
SELECTOR knob.
Turn the VOLUME knob to set the volume of
4.
the room used in the multi room system as you
like.
Note:
• The sleep timer, monaural output and other features
can also be set using the MAIN MENU.
(See page 55)
* Display when MULTI SPEAKER B is selected
MSB DVD -18dB
OPERATION OF THE MULTI ROOM OUTPUTS
WITH THE REMOTE CONTROL FROM MULTI A
Room A output can be operated from a room
where the unit (SR7002 or SR8002) is not installed.
This requires a separately sold IR receiver. (For
connections, see page 37.)
CHANGE THE MULTI ROOM CONTROL COMMANDS
(RC101) FOR MULTIROOM A
(When operating the unit by Multi Zone connected)
• Zone A: MULTI ROOM A Control (Default)
• Zone B: MULTI ROOM B Control
(The SR7002 does not use this zone.)
Change the control commands for each zone.
2.
1.
1. Press SET button and ZONE button until the
SEND indicator blinks twice.
Then backlight fl ashes.
2. Press A zone button.
When the procedure is successful, the SEND
indicator will blink twice.
These buttons change a special code of each zone.
POWER ON/OFF
Notes for the Multi Room System
• If the Tuner (FM or AM) is active in the main room,
you can not control any function of the tuner.In this
case, You must listen to the same station as the main
room.
OSD INFORMATION FOR THE MULTIROOM A SETUP
INFO
Press the INFO button to view the current setup as
shown below on a TV monitor connected to MULTI
VIDEO OUTPUT.
MULTI ROOM
VIDEO :DSS
AUDIO :DSS
SLEEP :90 min
MONO/ST:STEREO
OSD INFO:ENABLE
MULTI:ON MSPKR:OFF
VOL :VARI VOL :VARI
LEVEL:-20dB LEVEL:-90dB
--- MAIN ROOM STATUS --VIDEO:DVD AUDIO:DVD
OPERATION OF THE MULTI ROOM OUTPUTS
WITH THE REMOTE CONTROL FROM MULTI B
Room B output can be operated from a room
where the unit (SR7002 or SR8002) is not installed.
This requires a separately sold IR receiver. (For
connections, see page 37.)
Note:
The SR7002 does not use MULTIROOM B.
CHANGE THE MULTI ROOM CONTROL COMMANDS
(RC101) FOR MULTIROOM B
Change the control commands for each zone.
2.
1.
1. Press SET button and ZONE button until the
SEND indicator blinks twice.
Then backlight fl ashes.
2. Press B zone button.
When the procedure is successful, the SEND
indicator will blink twice.
These buttons change a special code of each zone.
POWER ON/OFF
Notes for the Multi Room System
• If the Tuner (FM or AM) is active in the main room,
you can not control any function of the tuner.In this
case, You must listen to the same station as the main
room.
OPERATION OF THE MULTI SPEAKER
OUTPUTS WITH THE REMOTE CONTROL
To switch to MULTI SPEAKER SYSTEM (A or B)
control, perform the following operations with the
RC101 set to MULTI ROOM A or MULTI ROOM B.
1.
2.
1. Press SET button and POWER ON button until
the SEND indicator blinks twice.
Then backlight fl ashes.
2. Press the DVD button.
Note
Press the TV button at this time to return to the MULTI
ROOM settings.
3. Press ENTER button once to lock in the code.
When the procedure is successful, the SEND
indicator will blink twice.
3.
1.
ENGLISH
SOURCE
VOL +/–
MUTE
Tuner mode operation remote code (Refer to page
26)
SOURCE
VOL +/–
MUTE
Tuner mode operation remote code (Refer to page
26)
79
ENGLISH
TROUBLESHOOTING
In case of trouble, check the following before calling for service:
1. Are the connections made properly ?
2. Are you operating the unit properly following the user’s guide ?
3. Are the power amplifi ers and speaker working properly ?
If the unit does not operate properly, check items shown in the following table.
If your trouble cannot be recovered with the remedy actions listed in the following table, malfunction of the
internal circuitry is suspected; immediately unplug the power cable and contact your dealer, nearest Marantz
authorized dealer or the Marantz Service Center in your country.
SYMPTOMCAUSEREMEDY
This unit cannot be turned
up.
No sound and picture are
output even when power is
on.
No speaker output.The headphones are connected to the
Incorrect Audio or Video for
selected source.
Incorrect Audio from a
channel.
No Audio output from the
center channel speaker.
No Audio output from the
surround speakers.
No Audio output from the
surround back speakers.
The power plug is not connected.
Mute is on.
The input cable is not connected
correctly.
The master volume control is turned all
the way down.
The function selector position is wrong.
headphone jack.
Input cable connected incorrectly.
Speaker cable connected incorrectly.
The center speaker cable connection is
incomplete.
STEREO has been selected for Surround
mode.
Center = NONE has been selected in
SETUP mode.
The surround speaker cable connection
is incomplete.
STEREO has been selected for Surround
mode.
Surround = NONE has been selected in
SETUP mode.
The surround back speaker cable
connection is incomplete.
Surround mode is not EX/ES mode.
Surround back = NONE has been
selected in SPEAKERS SIZE SETUP
Connect the power plug to the outlet.
Cancel mute using the remote controller.
See the connection diagram and connect the cables
correctly.
Adjust the master volume.
Select correct position.
Disconnect the headphones. (Speakers will not
output sound when headphones are connected.)
Connect the cable correctly by referring to the
connection diagram.
Connect the cable correctly by referring to the
connection diagram.
Connect the cable correctly.
When STEREO is selected for Surround mode, no
sound will be output from the center speaker. Set
another Surround mode.
Make the correct setting.
Connect the cable correctly.
When STEREO has been selected for Surround
mode, no sound will be output from the surround
speaker. Set another Surround mode.
Make the correct setting.
Connect the cable correctly.
Set surround mode EX/ES.
Make the correct setting.
SYMPTOMCAUSEREMEDY
Can not select EX/ES mode.Surround center= NONE has been
Can not select Pro Logic II x
mode.
Can not select Neo:6 mode.Input signal is incompatible.
Can not select CSII mode.Input signal is incompatible.
No output to Subwoofer Out.Subwoofer = NONE has been selected
Noise is produced during
DTS-encoded CD or laser
disc play.
A specifi c channel does not
produce output.
FM or AM reception fails.Antenna connection is incomplete.
Noise is heard during AM
reception.
Noise is heard during FM
reception.
Cannot get programmed
station when the PRESET
button is pressed.
Control with the remote
controller fails.
Auto Setup (SPEAKER
SETUP) is not working.
selected in SPEAKERS SIZE SETUP
Input signal is incompatible.
Input signal is incompatible.
in SETUP mode.
Analog has been selected for input.
Nothing recorded on source.
Reception is affected by other electrical
fi elds.
The radio waves from the broadcasting
station are weak.
Preset data has been erased.
Batteries are consumed.
Remote controller's function-key setting
is wrong.
The distance between this unit and the
remote commander is too far.
Something is blocking the unit and the
remote commander.
Headphones are connected.
Make the correct setting.
Use 5.1channel source.
Use 2 channel Dolby Digital input signal, PCM input
signal or analog input signal.
Use 2 channel DTS input signal, PCM input signal or
analog input signal.
Use 2 channel Dolby Digital input signal, PCM input
signal or analog input signal.
Select Subwoofer = YES.
Be sure to perform digital connection, select digital
input, then play.
Check the encoded channel on the source side.
Correctly connect the indoor FM and AM antennas
to FM and AM antenna outlets.
Try changing location where the AM indoor antenna
is set up.
Install an FM outdoor antenna.
Disconnecting power plug for long periods of time
will erase preset data. If that happens, input the
preset data again.
Replace all the batteries with new ones.
Select different position from which equipment will
be controlled.
Move closer to this unit.
Remove offending object.
Disconnect the headphones.
80
HDMI
SYMPTOMCAUSEREMEDY
The display does not
appear over an HDMI
connection.
Time is needed for the
display of an HDMI
connection to appear.
Audio is not played
back over an HDMI
connection.
DVD-Audio is not played
back over an HDMI
connection.
The connected monitor or projector
does not support HDCP.
The HDMI input of on the TV is
not on.
The HDMI output on the source
component (DVD, Set Top Box,
etc.) is not on.
The HDMI mode is not correctly
set on the unit.
The HDMI output video resolution
of the source component (DVD,
Set Top Box, etc.) does not match
the TV specifi cations.
The device is connected with a
non-standard HDMI cable.
Power to the unit is off. (When
the unit is on standby, HDMI
connections cannot be turned
on.)
The connection between
HDMI components was not
authenticated.
The connection is being
authenticated between the HDMI
devices.
The HDMI audio output of the
source component (DVD, Set Top
Box, etc.) is not on.
The signal format of the source
component (DVD, Set Top Box,
etc.) is not supported by the unit.
This unit is set to the HDMI audio
“THROUGH” mode.
The DVD player does not support
CPPM, therefore it cannot output
HDMI audio.
Set HDMI input so that it turns on, as
explained in the TV's instruction manual.
Set HDMI output so that it turns on, as
explained in the source component's
instruction manual.
Set HDMI input on the FUNC INPUT
SETUP menu as explained on page 43.
Set the resolution so that it matches, as
explained in the instruction manuals of both
components.
A 5 m or shorter cable is recommended to
ensure stable operation and prevent image
quality deterioration.
Turn on the power to the unit.
Shut off and then turn the power back on to
the unit, TV and source component.
There is nothing wrong with the system.
Some HDMI devices require time for
authentication.
Set the HDMI audio output so that it turns
on, as explained in the source component's
instruction manual.
Set the HDMI audio output so that it can
connect to the unit, as explained in the
source component's instruction manual.
In the “THROUGH” mode, sound is not
produced from the unit. Set it to “ENABLE”.
(see page 54)
• Use a DVD-Audio player that supports
CPPM.
• Turn on PCM downsampling on the DVD
player.
• Use an analog connection.
XM SATELLITE RADIO
If a problem should arise, fi rst check the following.
1. Are the connections correct?
2. Have you operated the receiver according to the operating instructions?
3. Are the speakers and other components operating properIy?
If this unit is not operating properly, Check the items listed in the table beIow. Should the problem persist, there
may be a malfunction. Disconnect the power immediately and contact your store of purchase.
SYMPTOMCAUSEREMEDY
“ANTENNA” is displayed.XM terminal and the XM Mini-Tuner and
“NO SIGNAL” is displayed.The signal cannot be received.Reposition your XM Mini-Tuner and Home
Receiving only XM channels 0 and 1.The XM Tuner is not activated.Contact XM Radio.
Home Dock is not properly connected.
Check that the connection are correct.
Dock.
HD Radio RECEPTION
SYMPTOMCAUSEREMEDY
The signal is not digital, even when
receiving from an HD Radio station.
(SR8002 only)
The signal sometimes switches from
digital to analog or the sound cuts out
when receiving from an HD Radio station.
(SR8002 only)
PROTECTIVE FEATURE
In some cases, the STANDBY indicator may blink slowly, twice per second. In this case, turn off the unit, unplug
the power cord, and check the following points.
• Make sure the speaker cables are not reversed and connected to the wrong sides (+ and -) on the unit.
• Make sure the speaker cables connected to the unit are not shorted. (Check both the unit end and the speaker
end.)
• Make sure the volume does not exceed the level that the unit is capable of producing.
• When using the unit in a rack or other enclosed space, heat may build up inside the unit and cause a fi re. When
installing the unit, be sure to leave suffi cient space between the top, back and both sides of the unit and walls or
other AV components to prevent the internal temperature from rising.
After checking these points, plug in the power cord and use the remote controller to turn on the unit. Turn down
the volume before resuming playback. Confi rm that there are no problems with the speaker connections and
playback performance.
If this symptom recurs, request service at your nearest service center.
In rare instances, the unit may enter standby mode and the STANDBY indicator may blink rapidly, 8 times per
second. In this case, unplug the power cord and request service at your nearest service center.
Reception is affected by other electrical
fi elds. (AM)
The radio waves from the broadcasting
station are weak. (FM)
Reception is affected by other electrical
fi elds. (AM)
The radio waves from the broadcasting
station are weak. (FM)
Try changing location where the AM
indoor antenna is set up.
Install an FM outdoor antenna.
Set the TUNER MODE to Analog Auto
mode or Analog Mono mode.
Note:
In this case you cannot receive a
digital signal. (See page.70)
ENGLISH
81
ENGLISH
STANDBY
POWER ON/OFF
INPUT SELECTOR
AV SURROUND RECEIVER SR8002
PHONES
PURE DIRECT
SLEEP
DSD
SURROUND
MODE AUTO
PURE DIRECT THX
EXITMULTIAUTOSPEAKERS A/B
V-OFFDISP MULTI AUTO TUNED ST SPKR A B
PEAK ANALOG
ATT
DIGITAL
SURR DIRECT
NIGHT
DISC 6.1 MTX 6.1
EQ
AUTO
AAC
PCM
MULTI
BAND
SPEAKER
MULTI
T-MODE
7.1CH INPUT
DISPLAY
ENTER
MENU
EXIT
DIGITAL
LCR
SL S SR
SURROUND
LFE
MEMORY CLEAR
DOWN
SPEAKERS
M-DAX
A/B
DIGITAL
MIC
FRONT KEY (BUTTON) LOCK OF THE UNIT
To lock all front panel buttons (except the POWER
ON/OFF button) and the INPUT SELECTER and
VOLUME knobs, hold the AUTO and EXIT buttons on
the front panel simultaneously for at least 3 seconds.
At this time, “F-KEY LOCK!” is displayed.
To unlock the controls, press the same buttons again
simultaneously for at least 3 seconds. At this time,
“F-KEY UNLOCK” is displayed, and the buttons are
released.
GENERAL MALFUNCTION
If the equipment malfunctions, this may be because
an electrostatic discharge or AC line interference has
corrupted the information in the equipment memory
circuits. Therefore:
- disconnect the plug from the AC line supply
- after waiting at least three minutes, reconnect
the plug to the AC line supply
- re-attempt to operate the equipment
Memory backup
• In case a power outage occurs or the power
cord is accidentally unplugged, this unit is
equipped with a backup function to prevent
memory data such as the preset memory
from being erased.
HOW TO RESET THE UNIT
Should the operation or display seem to be abnormal,
reset the unit with the following procedure.
This unit is turned on, press and hold the MULTI
+ SPEAKERS A/B buttons simultaneously for 3
seconds or more.
Remember that the procedure will reset the settings
of the function selector, Surround mode, delay time,
TUNER PRESET etc., to their initial settings.
VOLUME
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
UP
FM TUNER SECTION
Frequency Range ................................87.5 – 107.9 MHz
PAGE Command Note
PAGE 1 1 FM SELECT FM
2 AM SELECT AM
3 XM/DAB SELECT XM RADIO
4 NEURAL SELECT NEURAL AUDIO
5 BAND SELECT RADIO BAND
PAGE 2 1 SCAN + FREQUENCY SCAN UP
2 SCAN - FREQUENCY SCAN DOWN
3 T-MODE SELECT MONO/STEREO
4 P-SCAN SELECT PRESET SCAN
5 P-INFO SHOW PRESET INFORMATION
PAGE 3 1 DISP DISPLAY
European 2 PTY RDS PTY
model only 3 AF RDS ALTERNATE FREQEMCY
4 STM RDS STATION MODE
5 DWR RDS DSR WAVE LANGUAGE
PAGE 4 1 SCAN + FREQUENCY SCAN UP
2 SCAN - FREQUENCY SCAN DOWN
3 DISP XM/RDS DISPLAY
4 CAT + CATEGORY SEARCH UP
5 CAT - CATEGORY SEARCH DOWN
SELECT DOLBY MODE
2
STEREO
PAGE Command Note
PAGE 1 1 MENU SELECTS MAIN MENU
2 AUDIO SELECT LANGUAGES
3 SUB-T SELECT SUB TITLE
4 10+ DIGIT ENTRY +10
5 TRAY TRAY OPEN/CLOSE
PAGE 2 1 SETUP SELECTS SETUP MENU
2 ANGLE SELECTS ANGLE
3 OSD
4 FF FAST FORWARD
5 REW REWIND
PAGE 3 1 SLOW SLOW FORWARD
2 L-PLAY LAST PLAY
3 SHUFLE SHUFFLE PLAY
4 REPEAT REPEAT MODE
5 A/B REPEAT A TO B
PAGE 4 1 RETURN RETURN TO MENU
2 T/C TITLE AND CHAPTER
3 3-D SURROUND ON/OFF
4 TITLE SELECTS TITLE MENU
5 ZOOM ZOOM MODE ON/OFF
Source button name : CD
PAGE Command Note
PAGE 1 1 DISC + CD CHANGER NEXT DISC
2 DISC - CD CHANGER PREVIOUS DISC
3 SHUFLE SHUFFLE PLAY
4 REPEAT REPEAT
5 TRAY TRAY OPEN/CLOSE
PAGE 2 1 TEXT ACTIVATE TEXT FUNCTION
2 AMS AUTO MUSIC SCAN
3 SCROLL SCROLL/RECALL
4 FF FAST FORWARD
5 REW REWIND
PAGE 3 1 DISC 1 CD CHANGER DISC 1
2 DISC 2 CD CHANGER DISC 2
3 DISC 3 CD CHANGER DISC 3
4 DISC 4 CD CHANGER DISC 4
5 DISC 5 CD CHANGER DISC 5
PAGE 4 1 UNIT SELECT UNIT No.
2 TITL-S SELECT TITLE SEARCH
3 TRACK SELECT TRACK No.
4 CATGRY SELECT CATEGORY
5 P-MODE SELECT PLAY MODE
4 PROG ACTIVATE PROGRAM MODE
5 TRAY TRAY OPEN/CLOSE
PAGE 2 1 SCROLL SCROLL/RECALL
2 FINAL FINALIZES(WRITES TOC)
3 BLANK RECORDS BLANK
4 FF FAST FORWARD
5 REW REWIND
PAGE 3 1 BLANK RECORDS BLANK
2 REPEAT ACTIVATE REPEAT MODE
3
4
5
Source button name : TAPE
PAGE Command Note
PAGE 1 1 TAPE-A SELECT TAPE DECK A
2 TAPE-B SELECT TAPE DECK B
3 DIR AUTO REVERSE DIRECTION
4 TIME TIME DISPLAY
5 TRAY TRAY OPEN/CLOSE
PAGE 2 1 AMS AUTO MUSIC SCAN
2
3
4 FF FAST FORWARD
5 REW REWIND
PAGE Command Note
PAGE 1 1 SHUFFL SELECT SHUFFLE PLAY
2 REPEAT SELECT REPEAT PLAY
3 MODE
4 SORT SORT DATA BASE
5 MUTE MUTE ON/OFF (TOGGLE)
PAGE 2 1 ALBUM+ NEXT ALBUM
2 ALBUM- PREVIOUS ALBUM
3 LIST+ NEXT PLAY LIST
4 LIST- PREVIOUS PLAY LIST
5
PAGE 3 1 ARTIST SORT ORDER (ARTIST)
2 ALBUM SORT ORDER (ALBUM)
3 SONG SORT ORDER (SONG)
4 GENRE SORT ORDER (GENRE)
5 P-LIST SORT ORDER (PLAY LIST)
PAGE 4 1 1 INPUT+ INPUT SELECTOR FORWARD
2 INPUT- INPUT SELECTOR REVERSE
3
4
5